Casio Electronic Keyboard AT 3 User Manual

E
USER’S GUIDE  
Please keep all information for future reference.  
Safety Precautions  
Before trying to use the keyboard, be sure to read the  
separate “Safety Precautions”.  
AT3/AT5-E-1B  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Important!  
Please note the following important information before using this product.  
• Before using the optional AC Adaptor to power the unit, be sure to check the AC Adaptor for any damage first. Carefully check  
the power cord for breakage, cuts, exposed wire and other serious damage. Never let children use an AC adaptor that is  
seriously damaged.  
• Never attempt to recharge batteries.  
• Do not use rechargeable batteries.  
• Never mix old batteries with new ones.  
• Use recommended batteries or equivalent types.  
• Always make sure that positive (+) and negative (–) poles are facing correctly as indicated near the battery compartment.  
• Replace batteries as soon as possible after any sign they are getting weak.  
• Do not short-circuit the battery terminals.  
• The product is not intended for children under 3 years.  
• Use only a CASIO AD-A12150LW adaptor.  
• The AC adaptor is not a toy.  
• Be sure to disconnect the AC adaptor before cleaning the product.  
This mark applies in EU countries only.  
Manufacturer:  
CASIO COMPUTER CO.,LTD.  
6-2, Hon-machi 1-chome, Shibuya-ku, Tokyo 151-8543, Japan  
Responsible within the European Union:  
CASIO EUROPE GmbH  
Casio-Platz 1, 22848 Norderstedt, Germany  
Any reproduction of the contents of this manual, either in part or its entirety, is prohibited. Except for your own, personal  
use, any other use of the contents of this manual without the consent of CASIO is prohibited under copyright laws.  
IN NO EVENT SHALL CASIO BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER (INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION,  
DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF PROFITS, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION, LOSS OF INFORMATION) ARISING OUT OF THE  
USE OF OR INABILITY TO USE THIS MANUAL OR PRODUCT, EVEN IF CASIO HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE  
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.  
The contents of this manual are subject to change without notice.  
The actual appearance of the product may be different from that shown in the illustrations in this User’s Guide.  
Company and product names used in this manual may be registered trademarks of others.  
E-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
General Guide............................. E-4  
Using Auto Accompaniment....E-26  
Reading the Display ............................................... E-6  
Modes..................................................................... E-7  
Menus..................................................................... E-7  
, Precautions while “Please Wait” is displayed.... E-7  
Saving Settings....................................................... E-8  
Returning the Digital Keyboard to Its  
Playing an Auto Accompaniment.......................... E-26  
Selecting a Chord Fingering Mode....................... E-28  
Modifying Auto Accompaniment Patterns............. E-29  
Using One-Touch Presets .................................... E-29  
Using Auto Harmonize.......................................... E-30  
Factory Default Settings ......................................... E-8  
Applying Effects to a Sound....E-31  
Configuration of Effects ........................................ E-31  
Selecting an Effect................................................ E-33  
Creating a User DSP............................................ E-35  
Getting Ready to Play ................ E-9  
Preparing the Music Stand ..................................... E-9  
Power Supply ......................................................... E-9  
Using the Mixer .........................E-38  
Connections.............................. E-11  
Mixer Overview..................................................... E-38  
Mixer Operation.................................................... E-39  
Mixer Parameter Settings..................................... E-41  
Connecting Headphones...................................... E-11  
Connecting a Pedal .............................................. E-11  
Outputting Digital Keyboard Sound to  
Audio Equipment or an Amplifier.......................... E-11  
Outputting Input from an External Device or a  
Microphone through the Digital Keyboard’s  
Speakers .............................................................. E-12  
Bundled and Optional Accessories....................... E-12  
Using the Tone Editor...............E-44  
Tone Creation Overview....................................... E-44  
Creating a User Tone ........................................... E-45  
Tone Parameter Settings...................................... E-47  
Music Presets............................E-49  
Selecting and  
Playing a Tone .......................... E-13  
Using Music Presets............................................. E-49  
Creating a User Preset......................................... E-53  
Editing a Chord Progression................................. E-57  
To turn on Digital Keyboard power....................... E-13  
Listening to Demo Tunes...................................... E-14  
Selecting a Tone................................................... E-14  
Layering and Splitting Tones................................ E-15  
Raising and Lowering Keyboard Tuning  
(Transpose) .......................................................... E-18  
Using Octave Shift................................................ E-18  
Using the Metronome ........................................... E-19  
Using the Pitch Bend Wheel................................. E-20  
Applying Vibrato to Notes..................................... E-20  
Playing Arpeggio Phrases Automatically  
Saving Keyboard Setups to  
Registration Memory ................E-61  
To save a setup to registration memory ............... E-62  
To recall a setup from registration memory.......... E-62  
Using the Song Sequencer ......E-63  
Starting One-touch Recording (EASY REC) ........ E-63  
What you can do with the song sequencer........... E-65  
Recording Individual Tracks ................................. E-67  
Re-recording Part of a Song  
(Punch-in Recording)............................................ E-71  
Using Panel Record to Rewrite Song  
(Arpeggiator)......................................................... E-21  
Playing with an  
Oriental Scale............................ E-22  
Using Quarter Tones ............................................ E-22  
Fine Tuning Keyboard Keys  
Header Settings.................................................... E-73  
Playing a Recorded Song..................................... E-74  
Editing a Song ...................................................... E-76  
Editing a Track...................................................... E-80  
Editing Events....................................................... E-82  
Directly Inputting Note Events (Step Input) .......... E-95  
(Scale Fine Tuning) .............................................. E-23  
Selecting a Preset Scale ...................................... E-23  
Saving Your Current Scale Setup  
(Scale Memory) .................................................... E-25  
Specifying whether the Current Scale Settings  
Should be Applied to Auto Accompaniment  
(Accomp Scale) .................................................... E-25  
E-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Using the Pattern  
Sequencer ................................. E-97  
Reference.................................E-143  
Error Messages .................................................. E-143  
Troubleshooting.................................................. E-145  
Specifications ..................................................... E-147  
Operating Precautions........................................ E-149  
DSP Effect List ................................................... E-150  
Fingering Guide.................................................. E-155  
Supported Input Characters ............................... E-155  
Chord Example List ............................................ E-156  
Assigning a MIDI Channel to Each Part ............. E-157  
Parameter List .................................................... E-158  
About the Pattern Sequencer ............................... E-97  
Creating a User Rhythm....................................... E-98  
Creating a User Rhythm by Combining  
Exiting Rhythm Parts (Easy Edit) ....................... E-107  
Editing Individual Events (Event Editor) ............. E-108  
Configuring Instrument Part Playback Settings  
(Part Parameters)............................................... E-111  
Instrument Part Operations ................................ E-113  
Accompaniment Pattern and  
Rhythm Operations............................................. E-115  
MIDI Implementation Chart  
Recording and  
Playing Audio.......................... E-116  
Audio Recording and Playback Functions.......... E-116  
Audio Recording and Playback Precautions ...... E-116  
Performing Audio Recording .............................. E-117  
Playing Back Audio............................................. E-121  
Using the Function Menu....... E-125  
Using the Function Menu.................................... E-125  
Function Menu Settings...................................... E-126  
Using a Memory Card............. E-131  
Loading and Removing a Memory Card............. E-132  
Entering the Card Mode ..................................... E-132  
Formatting a Memory Card................................. E-132  
Saving Digital Keyboard Data to a  
Memory Card...................................................... E-133  
Loading Data from a Memory Card .................... E-135  
To delete a file from a memory card................... E-136  
To rename a file on a memory card.................... E-136  
Playing a Music File from a Memory Card.......... E-137  
Connecting to a Computer .... E-140  
Minimum Computer System Requirements........ E-140  
Storing and Loading Digital Keyboard  
Memory Data...................................................... E-141  
Using Rhythm (Auto Accompaniment) Data  
from another Model ............................................ E-141  
Importing Data from Various Storage Media ...... E-142  
E-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Guide  
• Illustrations in this User’s Guide show the AT-5.  
L-1  
-
L-18  
C-1  
-
C-17  
Dial  
S-2  
S-1  
D-1  
-
D-17  
R-1  
-
R-20  
T-1  
-
T-9  
Back  
E-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Guide  
• In this manual, the term “Digital Keyboard” refers to the AT-3/AT-5.  
• This manual uses the numbers and names below to refer to buttons and controllers.  
• The following explains the meanings of the # and $ symbols that appear on the product console and with the key names below.  
# : Indicates a function that is enabled by holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION) button when pressing a button. For example, SONG SEQUENCER, #  
EDIT means that the EDIT function is enabled by depressing the R-13 (FUNCTION) button.  
$ : Indicates a function that is enabled by holding down the button for some time. For example, METRONOME, BEAT $ means that the BEAT function is  
enabled by holding down the button for some time.  
L-1 POWER button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13  
L-2 MAIN VOLUME knob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13  
L-3 MIC VOLUME knob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
TONE buttons  
R-1 [A] PIANO, 5 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 58, 89  
R-2 [B] E.PIANO, 1 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 58, 89  
R-3 [C] ORGAN, 2 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 58, 89, 90  
R-4 [D] GUITAR/BASS, • button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 58, 89  
R-5 [E] STRINGS, REST button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 95  
R-6 [F] BRASS/REED/PIPE button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14  
R-7 [G] ARABIC, 6 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 58, 89, 90  
R-8 [H] ORIENTAL, 7 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 58, 89, 90  
R-9 [I] SYNTH, 8 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 89, 90  
R-10 [J] OTHERS, , button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 89, 90  
R-11 [K] GM/DRUMS, . button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 95  
R-12 [L] USER TONES button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45  
RHYTHM buttons  
L-4 [A] POPS/ROCK/DANCE button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 26  
L-5 [B] JAZZ/EUROPEAN button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26  
L-6 [C] LATIN/WORLD button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26  
L-7 [D] ARABIC/ORIENTAL,  
MUSIC PRESET button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26, 49  
L-8 [E] PIANO RHYTHMS,  
ONE TOUCH PRESET button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26, 29, 49  
L-9 [F] USER RHYTHMS button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26, 29  
L-10 METRONOME, $BEAT button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19  
L-11 TEMPO w button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 R-13 FUNCTION button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125  
L-12 TEMPO q, #TAP button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 R-14 NO/y/–, YES/t/+,  
#TRANSPOSE buttons. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6, 14, 18, 26  
RHYTHM/SONG CONTROLLER buttons  
R-15 EXIT button  
R-16 ENTER button  
R-17 u, t, y, i buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7  
R-18 AUTO HARMONIZE/ARPEGGIATOR,  
$TYPE button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21, 30  
R-19 SPLIT button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16  
R-20 LAYER, $OCTAVE button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16, 18  
L-13 INTRO, REPEAT button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29, 75, 139  
L-14 NORMAL/FILL-IN, sREW button . . . . . . . 14, 29, 74, 137  
L-15 VARIATION/FILL-IN, dFF button . . . . . . . 14, 29, 74, 137  
L-16 SYNCHRO/ENDING, PAUSE button . . . . . . 26, 29, 74, 137  
L-17 START/STOP, PLAY/STOP,  
DEMO button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14, 26, 74, 137  
L-18 ACCOMP ON/OFF, $CHORDS,  
ORIENTAL SCALE buttons  
PART SELECT, DEMO button. . . . . . . . . . . 14, 26, 28, 138  
D-1 1 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
D-2 2 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
D-3 3 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
D-4 4 button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
D-5 STORE button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25  
D-6 KEY C button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
C-1 Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6  
C-2 AUDIO PLAY button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121  
C-3 AUDIO RECORD button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118  
C-4 PATTERN SEQUENCER, #EDIT button . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97  
C-5 SONG SEQUENCER, #EDIT button . . . . . . . . . . . 7, 67, 76  
C-6 RECORD button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63, 67, 68  
C-7 MIXER, #EFFECT button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33, 39  
C-8 TONE EDITOR, #SCALE button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23, 45  
C-9 CARD, #LOAD/SAVE button . . . . . . . . . . . 7, 132, 133, 135  
Dial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6, 14, 26  
#
D-7 KEY C button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
D-8 KEY D button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
b
D-9 KEY E button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
D-10 KEY E button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
D-11 KEY F button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
#
REGISTRATION buttons  
D-12 KEY F button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
D-13 KEY G button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
D-14 KEY A button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
C-10 BANK, DELETE button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58, 61, 87, 94  
C-11 1, INSERT button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58, 61, 89, 95  
C-12 2, COPY button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61, 89  
C-13 3, QUANTIZE button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61, 90  
C-14 4, STEP button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59, 61, 95  
C-15 5 button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61  
C-16 6 button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61  
C-17 STORE, #MENU button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7, 62  
b
D-15 KEY A button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
b
D-16 KEY B button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
D-17 KEY B button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22  
S-1 PITCH BEND wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
S-2 MODULATION button. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20  
T-1 SD CARD SLOT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131  
T-2 USB jack. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140  
T-3 SUSTAIN/ASSIGNABLE JACK. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11  
T-4 PHONES jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11  
T-5 INST IN jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
T-6 AUDIO IN jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
T-7 DC 12V jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9  
T-8 MIC IN jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12  
T-9 LINE OUT R, L/MONO jacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11  
E-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Guide  
Tempo, measure, beat area  
6
Reading the Display  
This section explains the contents of the Digital Keyboard’s  
Tempo is shown as the current setting value, as beats per  
minute. Auto Accompaniment, the metronome (page  
E-19), and other playback is performed at the tempo  
shown here. The MEASURE and BEAT values are  
counted up as Auto Accompaniment, the metronome, or  
other playback progresses.  
display screen.  
1
2
Currently Selected Item Indication  
The item that is currently selected on a display screen is  
indicated by thick brackets (%) and by a large dot (0). The  
currently selected item is the one that is affected by the R-14  
(–, +) buttons or dial operations.  
4 5  
6
3
Detailed information area  
1
2
This area displays a variety of information while the Digital  
Keyboard is being used. Use this area to confirm proper  
operation when changing values, when selecting a menu  
item, and when performing other operations.  
Level meter area  
On this screen, “RHYTHM” is selected because it is enclosed  
by thick brackets. This indicates that the rhythm setting can be  
changed.  
This level meter shows the volume level of the notes that  
are sounded when you play something on the keyboard or  
when Auto Accompaniment is played. There are a total of  
32 parts, 16 each in Group A and Group B. The L  
indicator will be displayed in the lower left corner while  
Group A parts are being indicated by the level meter, while  
the M indicator will be displayed in the lower left corner  
while Group B parts are being indicated.  
For details about parts, see “How Parts are Organized”  
(page E-38).  
Indicator areas  
3
The indicator area shows such information as the current  
mode (page E-7), the status of settings, the status of Auto  
Accompaniment, and other information.  
There are two types of indicators: text type indicators such  
as :, and pointer (K) type indicators. In the case of  
pointer type indicators, a setting or status is indicated by  
the location of the K next to fixed text along the sides of the  
display. For example, the location of the pointer (K) on the  
right side of the display in the sample below indicates  
REVERB.  
On this screen, “Touch” is selected because the 0 is next to  
it. This indicates that the value to the right of “Touch”, which is  
enclosed in thick brackets, can be changed.  
Registration bank area  
This area shows the number of the currently selected  
registration bank (page E-61).  
4
5
Chord area  
This area shows the chord being played when Auto  
Accompaniment (page E-26) or music preset (page E-49)  
is being used. It also can display fraction chords by  
showing the chord root (C, G, etc.) and type (m, 7th, etc.).  
E-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Guide  
Modes  
Menus  
Your Digital Keyboard has three modes: a rhythm mode, a  
card mode, and a song sequencer mode. The currently  
selected mode is shown as an indicator on the display.  
You can use the same operations to display mode and  
function specific menus. To display a menu, hold down the  
R-13 (FUNCTION) button as you press the C-17 (MENU)  
button. For example, the “Performance” menu shown below  
will appear if you perform the above operation while in the  
rhythm mode. This menu provides instant access to  
performance functions.  
Card mode  
C-9 (CARD) or  
C-9 (CARD) button  
R-15 (EXIT) button  
Rhythm mode  
C-5 (SONG  
SEQUENCER) button  
C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER) or  
R-15 (EXIT) button  
Song sequencer mode  
• The currently selected item is the one with the 0 next to it.  
You can use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 up  
and down. You also can use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to  
scroll between menu pages.  
• To exit a displayed menu, press the R-15 (EXIT) button.  
You may need to press the R-15 (EXIT) button more than  
once in some cases.  
• Rhythm mode (: indicator displayed)  
Under its initial factory default settings, the Digital Keyboard  
enters the rhythm mode whenever it is turned on. The  
rhythm mode is the base mode, and it is the mode you  
should enter when you want to play on the keyboard or use  
Auto Accompaniment.  
• Card mode (; indicator displayed)  
Enter the card mode when you want to perform memory  
card operations. See “Using a Memory Card” (page E-131)  
for more information.  
• The menu items and operations for specific modes and  
functions are described in each section of this user’s guide.  
,
Precautions while “Please  
– In the rhythm mode, pressing the C-9 (CARD) button will  
enter the card mode.  
Wait” is displayed  
– In the card mode, pressing the C-9 (CARD) button or the  
R-15 (EXIT) button will return to the rhythm mode.  
• Song sequencer mode (< indicator displayed)  
Enter the sequencer mode when you want to record  
performances using the keyboard and Auto  
Accompaniment, or to play back song data. For details, see  
“Using the Song Sequencer” (page E-63).  
– In the rhythm mode, pressing the C-5 (SONG  
SEQUENCER) button will enter the song sequencer  
mode.  
Never try to perform any operation, or insert or remove a  
memory card while the message “Please Wait” is on the  
display. Wait until the message disappears.  
• “Please Wait” indicates that the Digital Keyboard is  
performing a data save operation. Turning off the Digital  
Keyboard or removing the memory card can cause Digital  
Keyboard data to be deleted or become corrupted. It also  
can cause the Digital Keyboard to fail to turn on when the  
L-1 (POWER) button is pressed.  
• If this happens, refer to “Troubleshooting” (page E-145).  
– In the song sequencer mode, pressing the C-5 (SONG  
SEQUENCER) button or the R-15 (EXIT) button will  
return to the rhythm mode.  
• After entering any mode besides the rhythm mode and  
performing the operations you want, be sure to return  
to the rhythm mode.  
• Unless otherwise specifically noted, all of the  
operations described in this user’s guide are  
performed in the rhythm mode.  
E-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
General Guide  
Saving Settings  
Your Digital Keyboard is equipped with a song sequencer and  
other features that you can use to store data you create. This  
stored data is retained even when the Digital Keyboard is  
turned off.*  
However, the tone, rhythm, and other settings you configure  
on the Digital Keyboard’s console normally are returned to  
their initial power on defaults whenever you turn off power.  
You can configure the Digital Keyboard so it remembers its  
latest setup or to apply a predetermined default setup each  
time you turn it on. For details, see “AutoResume (Auto  
Resume)” (page E-129) and “Default (Default Settings)”  
(page E-129).  
* The following data and settings are always retained even  
when power is turned off.  
– Registration setup data (page E-61)  
– Song sequencer data (page E-63)  
– User rhythm data (page E-98)  
– User preset data (page E-53)  
– User tone data (page E-44)  
– Scale fine tuning setting (page E-23)  
– User DSP data (page E-35)  
– LCD Contrast setting (page E-128)  
– Auto Resume setting (page E-129)  
Returning the Digital Keyboard to  
Its Factory Default Settings  
You can delete all data in keyboard memory and return all  
keyboard parameters to their initial factory default settings.  
For details, see “To initialize all data and settings (or  
parameter settings only)” (page E-130).  
B
E-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting Ready to Play  
Using a Household Power Outlet  
Preparing the Music Stand  
Make sure that you use only the AC adaptor (JEITA Standard,  
with unified polarity plug) specified for this product. Use of a  
different type of AC adaptor can cause malfunction.  
Music stand  
Specified AC Adaptor: AD-A12150LW  
Use the supplied power cord to connect the AC adaptor as  
shown in the illustration below.  
T-7 (DC 12V) jack  
Household power outlet  
Power Supply  
Prepare a household power outlet or batteries.  
Power cord  
• Be sure to comply with the separate “Safety  
Precautions”. Incorrect use of this product creates the  
risk of electric shock and fire.  
AC adaptor  
• Always make sure that the product is turned off before  
plugging in or unplugging the AC adaptor, or before  
loading or removing batteries.  
• The shape of the power cord plug and household  
power outlet receptacle differ according to country and  
geographical area. The illustration shows just one  
example of the shapes that are available.  
• The AC adaptor will become warm to the touch after  
very long use. This is normal and does not indicate  
malfunction.  
• To prevent breaking of the wire, take care to avoid  
putting any type of load on the power cord.  
No bending!  
No winding!  
• Never insert metal, pencils, or any other objects into  
the product’s DC 12V jack. Doing so creates the risk of  
accident.  
E-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Getting Ready to Play  
Using Batteries  
Low Battery Indication  
The following shows the approximate battery life.  
4 hours* on alkaline batteries  
You can use six D-size batteries for power.  
• Use alkaline or zinc-carbon batteries.  
Never use oxyride or any other nickel based batteries.  
* The above values are standard battery life at normal  
temperature, with the volume at medium setting.  
Temperature extremes or playing at very loud volume  
settings can shorten battery life.  
1. Open the battery cover on the bottom of the  
Digital Keyboard.  
The indicators shown below start to flash to let you know  
when battery power is low. Replace the batteries with new  
ones.  
2. Load six D-size batteries into the battery  
compartment.  
• Make sure the positive + and negative - ends of the  
batteries are facing as shown in the illustration.  
Low battery indication (flashing)  
3. Insert the tabs of the battery cover into the  
holes on the side of the battery compartment,  
and close the cover.  
Tabs  
E-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connections  
Connecting Headphones  
Using headphones cuts off output from the built-in speakers,  
which means you can practice playing even late at night  
without disturbing others.  
Outputting Digital Keyboard  
Sound to Audio Equipment or an  
Amplifier  
• Be sure to turn down the volume level before connecting  
headphones.  
You can connect audio equipment or a music amplifier to the  
Digital Keyboard and then play through external speakers for  
more powerful volume and better sound quality.  
T-4 (PHONES) jack  
• Whenever connecting a device to the Digital Keyboard,  
first use the L-2 (MAIN VOLUME) knob to set the  
volume to a low level. After connecting, you can adjust  
the volume to the level you want.  
• Whenever you connect any device to the Digital  
Keyboard, be sure to read the user documentation that  
comes with the device.  
• Headphones do not come with the Digital Keyboard.  
• Use commercially available headphones.  
Pin plug  
Audio amplifier AUX IN jack, etc.  
RIGHT (Red)  
LEFT (White)  
• Do not listen to very high volume output over  
headphones for long periods. Doing so creates the risk  
of hearing damage.  
Guitar amplifier  
Keyboard amplifier, etc.  
INPUT 1  
• If you are using headphones that require an adaptor  
plug, make sure you do not leave the adaptor plugged  
in when removing the headphones.  
INPUT 2  
Standard plug  
Outputting Keyboard Notes to Audio  
Connecting a Pedal  
Equipment  
1
Connecting an optionally available pedal let’s you perform  
pedal operations that add more versatility to your keyboard  
play. For information about the types of effects that can be  
applied by pressing the pedal, see “Ped.Assign (Pedal  
Assign)” (page E-126).  
Use commercially available connecting cords to connect the  
external audio equipment to the Digital Keyboard’s T-9 (LINE  
OUT) jacks as shown in Figure . LINE OUT R jack output is  
1
right channel sound, while LINE OUT L/MONO jack output is  
left channel sound. It is up to you to purchase connecting  
cords like the ones shown in the illustration for connection of  
audio equipment. Normally in this configuration you must set  
the audio equipment’s input selector to the setting that  
specifies the terminal (such as AUX IN) to which the Digital  
Keyboard is connected. Use the L-2 (MAIN VOLUME) knob  
to adjust the volume level.  
T-3 (SUSTAIN/ASSIGNABLE JACK)  
Outputting Keyboard Notes to a Musical  
Instrument Amplifier  
2
Use a commercially available connecting cord to connect the  
amplifier to either of the Digital Keyboard’s T-9 (LINE OUT)  
jacks as shown in Figure . LINE OUT R jack output is right  
2
channel sound, while LINE OUT L/MONO jack output is left  
channel sound. Connecting to the LINE OUT L/ MONO jack  
only outputs a mixture of both channels. It is up to you to  
purchase a connecting cord like the one shown in the  
illustration for connection of the amplifier. Use the L-2 (MAIN  
VOLUME) knob to adjust the volume level.  
E-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connections  
Output of External Device Input that is  
Affected by the Digital Keyboard’s Effects  
Outputting Input from an External  
Device or a Microphone through  
the Digital Keyboard’s Speakers  
You can use the Digital Keyboard’s speakers to output sound  
from a CD player, another digital keyboard, or other external  
device, or from a microphone.  
Use a commercially available connecting cord to connect the  
external device to the Digital Keyboard’s T-5 (INST IN) jack.  
The connecting cord should have a standard plug (monaural)  
on one end and a plug that is compatible with the external  
device you are connecting to on the other end. Adjust volume  
using the Digital Keyboard’s L-2 (MAIN VOLUME) knob.  
• Whenever connecting something to the Digital  
Keyboard, first use the L-2 (MAIN VOLUME) knob to set  
the volume to a low level. After connecting, you can  
adjust the volume to the level you want.  
• Whenever you connect any device to the Digital  
Keyboard, be sure to read the user documentation that  
comes with the device.  
CD player,  
Portable audio player, etc.  
Standard plug (monaural)  
Outputting Sound with a Microphone  
You can connect a dynamic microphone (only) to the Digital  
Keyboard for output thorough the Digital Keyboard’s  
speakers.  
• Digital Keyboard built-in effects (reverb, chorus, DSP) are  
not applied to input from the T-6 (AUDIO IN) jack. Input is  
output directly, and is affected by the Digital Keyboard’s  
build-in amplifier and L-2 (MAIN VOLUME) knob.  
• Digital Keyboard built-in effects (reverb, chorus, DSP) are  
applied to input from the T-5 (INST IN) and T-8 (MIC IN)  
jacks. You also can use the Mixer to adjust how effects are  
applied, the speaker stereo pan position, and other  
parameters.  
T-8 (MIC IN) jack  
• You can adjust the volume level of microphone input with  
the L-3 (MIC VOLUME) knob. Microphone volume control  
is independent of overall keyboard volume.  
For details, see “Applying Effects to a Sound” (page E-31)  
and “Using the Mixer” (page E-38).  
Output of External Device Input that is Not  
Affected by the Digital Keyboard’s Effects  
• Before connecting a microphone, make sure that the  
Digital Keyboard and microphone are turned off.  
• Before connecting a microphone, set both the L-2  
(MAIN VOLUME) and L-3 (MIC VOLUME) knobs to low  
levels. Adjust volume settings to appropriate levels  
after connecting the microphone.  
Use a commercially available connecting cord to connect the  
external device to the Digital Keyboard’s T-6 (AUDIO IN) jack.  
The connecting cord should have a stereo mini plug on one  
end and a plug that is compatible with the external device you  
are connecting to on the other end. Adjust volume using the  
Digital Keyboard’s L-2 (MAIN VOLUME) knob.  
Bundled and Optional  
Accessories  
CD player,  
Portable audio player, etc.  
Use of unauthorized accessories creates the risk of fire,  
electric shock, and personal injury.  
Stereo mini plug  
• You can get information about accessories that are sold  
separately for this product from the CASIO catalog  
available from your retailer, and from the CASIO website at  
the following URL.  
http://world.casio.com/  
E-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting and Playing a Tone  
L-1  
L-4  
R-1  
-
R-12  
L-2  
R-14  
L-14  
L-15  
L-17  
L-18  
R-19  
R-20  
To turn on Digital Keyboard power  
• Under its initial configuration, the Digital Keyboard will  
return to its default settings whenever you turn it off.  
You can change the initial configuration to have the  
Digital Keyboard remember its latest setup or to apply  
a predetermined setup each time you turn it on. For  
details, see “AutoResume (Auto Resume)” (page  
E-129) and “Default (Default Settings)” (page E-129).  
• The message “Please Wait” will remain on the display  
while a data save operation is in progress. Do not  
perform any other operation while it is displayed.  
Turning off the Digital Keyboard or removing the  
memory card can cause Digital Keyboard data to be  
deleted or become corrupted. It also can cause the  
Digital Keyboard to fail to turn on when the L-1  
(POWER) button is pressed. If this happens, refer to  
“Troubleshooting” (page E-145).  
1. Rotate the L-2 (MAIN VOLUME) knob towards  
MIN to set the volume to a low level.  
2. Referring to “Connections” (page E-11),  
connect headphones, amplifier, or other device.  
3. Use the L-1 (POWER) button to turn on power.  
• The Digital Keyboard display screen will appear as  
shown below, which indicates that it is ready to play  
with a piano tone (using initial power on default  
settings).  
Auto Power Off  
This Digital Keyboard is designed to turn off automatically to  
avoid wasting power after no operation is performed for a  
preset amount of time. The Auto Power Off trigger time is six  
minutes under battery power and four hours under AC  
adaptor power.  
• To turn off the Digital Keyboard, press the L-1  
(POWER) button again.  
• Auto Power Off is enabled while “on” is selected for  
“AutoPower (Auto Power Off)” (page E-129). The initial  
default setting is “on”. To disable Auto Power Off, select  
“oFF” for “AutoPower” (Auto Power Off).  
• You also can use the procedure below to temporarily  
suspend Auto Power Off while it is enabled.  
E-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting and Playing a Tone  
To disable Auto Power Off  
Selecting a Tone  
1. While the Digital Keyboard is turned on, press  
The tones of this Digital Keyboard are divided among groups,  
each of which corresponds to one of the 12 TONE buttons.  
You can specify a tone by its group and its tone number.  
Use the following procedure to select a single tone that is  
applied across the entire keyboard.  
the L-1 (POWER) button to turn it off.  
2. While holding down the L-4 ([A] POPS/ROCK/  
DANCE) button, press the L-1 (POWER) button  
to turn on the Digital Keyboard.  
To select a tone  
1. Refer to the separate “Appendix” to look up the  
group and the number of the tone you want to  
select.  
2. Check to make sure that the @ and A  
• Auto Power Off will be disabled at this time.  
indicators are not on the display.  
• If they are displayed, press the R-19 (SPLIT) button  
and/or R-20 (LAYER) button to clear both indicators  
from the display.  
• Turning off the keyboard after performing the above steps  
will re-enable Auto Power Off.  
3. Use buttons R-1 ([A] PIANO) through R-12 ([L]  
Listening to Demo Tunes  
USER TONES) to select a tone group.  
1. While holding down the L-18 (ACCOMP ON/  
OFF) button, press the L-17 (PLAY/STOP)  
button.  
• The R-12 ([L] USER TONES) button selects the user  
tone group. For details, see “Using the Tone Editor”  
(page E-44).  
4. Use the dial to scroll through the tone numbers  
until the one you want is displayed.  
Example: Group [C], Number 004  
• This starts demo tune play.  
• The Digital Keyboard has a total of five demo tunes.  
You also can use the R-14 (–, +) buttons to select a  
demo tune.  
Number  
• Pressing the L-15 (dFF) button performs fast forward  
play of the demo tune, while the L-14 (sREW) button  
performs fast backward play. Holding down the L-14  
(sREW) button until playback reaches the beginning  
of the current song will stop playback there. Normal  
playback will resume when you release the L-14  
(sREW) button. Holding down the L-15 (dFF)  
button continues fast forward playback, even after the  
end of a song is reached.  
Tone name  
Group  
• You can play along on the keyboard with demo tune  
play. Note, however, that you cannot change the tone  
assigned to the keyboard. Only the key operations  
described above are supported during demo tune  
playback.  
2. To stop demo tune playback, press the L-17  
(PLAY/STOP) button.  
E-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting and Playing a Tone  
• Three tones, two layered tones for the right range and  
one tone for the left range of the keyboard (page E-17)  
This configuration uses the UPPER 1 part, UPPER 2 part,  
and LOWER part (Layer: On, Split: On).  
5. Now you can play on the keyboard using the  
tone you selected.  
• You also can use the R-14 (–, +) buttons to select a tone.  
Holding down either button will scroll through tone numbers  
at high speed. Pressing both of the R-14 (–, +) buttons at  
the same time will select tone 001 in the currently selected  
group.  
UPPER 1  
LOWER  
UPPER 2  
Layering and Splitting Tones  
You can configure the keyboard to play two different tones at  
the same time (Layer) or to play different tones in the left and  
right ranges (Split). You can even use Layer and Split in  
combination with each other and play three different tones at  
the same time.  
The UPPER 1 part is used alone when playing an individual  
tone on the keyboard. When layering two tones, the UPPER 1  
part and UPPER 2 parts are used. When splitting the  
keyboard between two tones, the low range of the keyboard  
plays the LOWER part.  
• You can configure the settings described below to adjust  
each part when using multiple tones in layer and split  
configurations.  
To adjust this setting for  
each part:  
Go here for more  
information:  
Octave shift  
Using Octave Shift  
(page E-18)  
Volume balance  
Using the Mixer (page E-38)  
Stereo position, effect  
(reverb, chorus) levels, and  
other detailed settings  
• One tone across the entire keyboard (page E-14)  
This configuration uses the UPPER 1 part only (Layer: Off,  
Split: Off).  
UPPER 1  
• Two layered tones across the entire keyboard (page  
E-16)  
This configuration uses the UPPER 1 part and UPPER 2  
part (Layer: On, Split: Off).  
UPPER 1  
UPPER 2  
• Two tones, one for the left range and one for the right  
range of the keyboard (page E-17)  
This configuration uses the UPPER 1 part and LOWER part  
(Layer: Off, Split: On).  
LOWER  
UPPER 1  
E-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting and Playing a Tone  
R-14  
R-19  
R-20  
To layer two tones  
To split the keyboard between two tones  
1. Refer to the separate “Appendix” to look up the  
group(s) and numbers of the two tones (UPPER  
1 part tone and UPPER 2 part tone) you want to  
use.  
1. Refer to the separate “Appendix” to look up the  
group(s) and numbers of the tones (UPPER 1  
part tone and LOWER part tone) you want to  
use.  
2. Check to make sure that the @ and A  
2. Check to make sure that the @ and A  
indicators are not on the display.  
indicators are not on the display.  
• If they are displayed, press the R-19 (SPLIT) button  
and/or R-20 (LAYER) button to clear both indicators  
from the display. When neither indicator is displayed,  
the tone you select will become the UPPER 1 part tone.  
• If they are displayed, press the R-19 (SPLIT) button  
and/or R-20 (LAYER) button to clear both indicators  
from the display. When neither indicator is displayed,  
the tone you select will become the UPPER 1 part tone.  
3. Use the TONE buttons and dial to select the  
3. Use the TONE buttons and dial to select the  
UPPER 1 part tone.  
UPPER 1 part tone.  
4. Press the R-20 (LAYER) button.  
4. Press the R-19 (SPLIT) button.  
• This causes the A indicator to appear on the  
display. This indicates that the tone you select will  
become the UPPER 2 part tone.  
• This causes the @ indicator to appear on the  
display. This indicates that the tone you select will  
become the LOWER part tone.  
5. Use the TONE buttons and dial to select the  
5. Use the TONE buttons and dial to select the  
UPPER 2 part tone.  
LOWER part tone.  
6. Play something on the keyboard to check how  
6. Play something on the left and right sides of the  
keyboard to confirm that the tones are assigned  
properly.  
the tones sound layered together.  
7. To cancel tone layering, press the R-20 (LAYER)  
button again so the A indicator disappears  
from the display.  
• You also can specify the keyboard split point, which is  
the location where the keyboard splits between the left  
range and right range. For details, see “To specify the  
keyboard split point” (page E-17).  
7. To cancel keyboard split, press the R-19 (SPLIT)  
button so the @ indicator disappears from  
the display.  
E-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting and Playing a Tone  
To use layer and split together  
To specify the keyboard split point  
1. While holding down the R-19 (SPLIT) button,  
press the keyboard key that you want to be the  
leftmost key in the right side (UPPER 1 part)  
range.  
1. Perform steps 1 through 6 of the procedure  
under “To layer two tones” (page E-16).  
2. Refer to the separate “Appendix” to look up the  
group and the number of the tone you want to  
assign to for the LOWER part.  
LOWER part UPPER 1 part  
3. Press the R-19 (SPLIT) button.  
• This causes the @ indicator to appear on the  
display. This indicates that the tone you select will  
become the LOWER part tone.  
Key you press  
4. Use the TONE buttons and dial to select the  
LOWER part tone.  
Split point  
5. Play something on the left and right sides of the  
keyboard to confirm that the tones are assigned  
properly.  
• The name of the key you press will appear on the  
display as the new split point key name.  
• You also can use the R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
displayed split point key name.  
• The right keyboard area plays the UPPER 1 and  
UPPER 2 tones in a layered configuration, while the left  
keyboard area plays the LOWER tone.  
2. When you are finished, release the R-19 (SPLIT)  
6. To cancel keyboard split, press the R-19 (SPLIT)  
button so the @ indicator disappears from  
the display.  
button.  
• The initial default split point is at key F#3.  
• During Auto Accompaniment play (page E-26), the  
keyboard to the left of the split point becomes the chord  
keyboard.  
7. To cancel tone layering, press the R-20 (LAYER)  
button again so the A indicator disappears  
from the display.  
E-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting and Playing a Tone  
Raising and Lowering Keyboard  
Tuning (Transpose)  
The transpose feature lets you raise or lower the overall  
tuning of the keyboard in semitone steps. You can use this  
feature to adjust keyboard tuning to a key that better matches  
a vocalist, another musical instrument, etc.  
Using Octave Shift  
You can use octave shift to individually change the octave of  
the UPPER 1, UPPER 2, and LOWER parts. You can use  
octave shift to raise or lower the octave of a song, to assign  
different octaves to the left side and right side keyboards while  
the keyboard is split, or to play two notes in different octaves  
while the keyboard is layered.  
1. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
1. Hold down the R-20 (OCTAVE) button until the  
octave shift screen shown below appears on  
the display.  
button, press one of the R-14 (–, +) buttons.  
Octave shift amount (Octave unit)  
Part name  
• This displays the transpose screen shown below.  
• This indicates you can change the UPPER 1 part  
octave.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify the  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
change the setting value.  
octave shift amount.  
• You can shift the octave within the range of –2 to 0 to  
+2.  
• You can change the tuning of the keyboard within the  
range of –12 to 00 to +12.  
3. If you want to change the octave of the  
UPPER 2 part, press the R-20 (OCTAVE) button.  
3. Press the R-13 (FUNCTION) button.  
• This will cause “UPPER 2” to appear on the display,  
indicating that you can change the UPPER 2 part  
octave. Perform the same operation as in step 2 to  
specify the octave shift amount.  
• This exits the transpose screen.  
• Setting a transposed value other than 00 will cause the  
B indicator to appear on the display.  
• The current transpose setting is applied to the notes of all  
parts (UPPER 1, UPPER 2, LOWER, Auto Accompaniment,  
etc.) played on the keyboard. The MIDI out note number  
when a keyboard key is pressed is also shifted in  
accordance with the transpose setting.  
4. If you want to change the octave of the LOWER  
part, press the R-20 (OCTAVE) button.  
• This will cause “LOWER” to appear on the display,  
indicating that you can change the LOWER part octave.  
Perform the same operation as in step 2 to specify the  
octave shift amount.  
5. Press the R-20 (OCTAVE) button or the R-15  
(EXIT) button.  
• This exits the octave shift screen.  
E-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting and Playing a Tone  
To change the tempo setting  
Using the Metronome  
There are two different methods you can use to change the  
tempo setting: using the TEMPO buttons or tapping a beat  
with a button.  
1. Press the L-10 (METRONOME) button.  
To change the tempo using the TEMPO buttons  
1. Press the L-11 (TEMPO w) (slower) or L-12  
(TEMPO q) (faster) button.  
• This will start the metronome.  
• The display will show the tempo along with a count of  
the measures and beats since you started the  
metronome.  
• This displays the tempo screen shown below.  
Tempo  
Beat  
• If you do not perform any operation for a few seconds,  
the display will return to previous screen automatically.  
Measure  
2. Press the L-10 (METRONOME) button again to  
2. Use the L-11 (TEMPO w) and L-12 (TEMPO q)  
buttons to change the tempo (beats per  
minute).  
stop the metronome.  
To change the beats per measure  
• Holding down either button will scroll the setting values  
at high speed.  
• You can specify a tempo value in the range of 30 to  
255.  
1. Hold down the L-10 (BEAT) button until the  
metronome beat screen shown below appears  
on the display.  
3. Press the R-15 (EXIT) button.  
• This exits the tempo screen.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select a  
beat setting.  
• You can select 0, or a value within the range of 2 to 6.  
Specifying 0 for this setting will cause each beat to be  
indicated by the same sound (no chime at the  
beginning of each measure).  
3. Press the L-10 (BEAT) or R-15 (EXIT) button.  
• This exits the metronome beat screen.  
E-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting and Playing a Tone  
To adjust the tempo by tapping a beat  
Using the Pitch Bend Wheel  
1. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, tap the L-12 (TAP) button four times at  
the speed (tempo) you want to set.  
The PITCH BEND wheel (S-1) lets you change the pitch of  
notes you are playing by rotating the wheel forward or back.  
Rotating the wheel away from you raises the pitch, while  
rotating it towards you lowers it. Releasing the wheel causes  
the pitch of the notes to return to normal automatically.  
• The first tap of the L-12 (TAP) button will cause the  
display shown below to appear.  
• Do not have the pitch bend wheel rotated as you turn  
on the keyboard.  
• You also can change the range of the pitch bend wheel  
(bend range) globally or for a specific part. For details, see  
“BendRange (Bend Range)” (page E-126) and “Part  
Parameters” (page E-43).  
• The tempo setting will change in accordance with your  
tapping speed as soon as you tap the fourth time.  
• The setting will be canceled if you release the R-13  
(FUNCTION) button before tapping the L-12 (TAP)  
button four times.  
Applying Vibrato to Notes  
2. After setting the tempo by tapping, you then  
can use the procedure under “To change the  
tempo using the TEMPO buttons” (page E-19) to  
make fine adjustments.  
You can apply vibrato to notes you play on the keyboard (all  
UPPER 1, UPPER 2, LOWER part notes) by hand. Vibrato is  
applied to notes while the S-2 (MODULATION) button is  
depressed. Releasing the button stops application of vibrato  
(under initial default settings).  
• Instead of vibrato, you can assign a different DSP effect to  
the S-2 (MODULATION) button, if you want. For details,  
see information about the following parameters in “DSP  
Parameter Settings” (page E-37) and “Tone Parameter  
Settings” (page E-47).  
– Mod Button Assign (Modulation Button Assign)  
– Mod Button On Value (Modulation Button On Value)  
– Mod Button Off Value (Modulation Button Off Value)  
E-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting and Playing a Tone  
4. Press the R-18 (AUTO HARMONIZE/  
Playing Arpeggio Phrases  
Automatically (Arpeggiator)  
With the arpeggiator, you can play various arpeggios and  
other phrases automatically by simply pressing keys on the  
keyboard. You can select from a number of different  
arpeggiator options, including playing arpeggios from a chord,  
playing various phrases automatically, and more.  
ARPEGGIATOR) button.  
• This causes a pointer indicator to appear on the display  
next to ARPEGGIATOR.  
1. Hold down the R-18 (AUTO HARMONIZE/  
ARPEGGIATOR) button until the type selection  
screen shown below appears on the display.  
Lit  
5. Configure arpeggiator settings as required.  
• The settings you can configure are described in the  
table below. For information about how to configure  
settings, see “To change the setting of a function menu  
item” (page E-125).  
For information about this setting:  
Go here:  
ArpegHold  
Whether arpeggio should be played  
while keyboard keys are depressed or (Arpeggiator Hold)  
after the keys are released  
(page E-126)  
The number of times arpeggio is  
played within one beat  
ArpegSpeed  
(Arpeggiator  
Speed) (page  
E-127)  
When the keyboard is split between  
two tones, whether arpeggio should  
ArpegPart  
(Arpeggiator Part)  
be played when UPPER keyboard or (page E-127)  
LOWER keyboard keys are pressed  
Type number  
Type name  
6. On the keyboard, play a chord or a single note.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select the  
• Arpeggio is played in accordance with the currently  
selected arpeggiator type and the note(s) you play.  
arpeggiator type you want to use.  
• You can select one of the arpeggiator types (013  
through 162). Refer to the separate “Appendix” for  
detailed information about supported arpeggiator types.  
• When selecting the arpeggiator type, you can assign  
the recommended tone for the currently displayed type  
as the keyboard tone, by holding down the R-18 (AUTO  
HARMONIZE/ARPEGGIATOR) button until a pointer  
indicator starts to flash on the display next to  
ARPEGGIATOR.  
7. To turn off the arpeggiator, press the R-18  
(AUTO HARMONIZE/ARPEGGIATOR) button  
again.  
• This causes the pointer indicator next to  
ARPEGGIATOR to disappear from the display.  
Flashing  
• For information about type number 001 through 012,  
see “Using Auto Harmonize” (page E-30).  
3. Press the R-15 (EXIT) button.  
• This exits the type selection screen.  
E-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing with an Oriental Scale  
C-8  
R-13  
R-14  
R-15  
R-16  
R-17  
You can change the scale of the keyboard to various Oriental  
scales or other temperaments.  
The C indicator also appears on the display.*2  
• The settings you configure with the scale function are  
retained even when the Digital Keyboard is turned off.  
Using Quarter Tones  
You can use the procedure below to instantly lower the note  
assigned to all the keyboard keys that play it by one quarter  
tone (50 cents) and to return it to its original tuning.  
Indicator*2  
*1 Lit while the tuning of the note that corresponds to the  
button is lowered from its normal (equal temperament)  
tuning.  
*2 Indicates that at least one of the 12 notes has been  
changed from normal (equal temperament) tuning.  
1. Use buttons D-6 (KEY C) through D-17 (KEY B)  
to specify the note you want to lower. Press the  
button with the note name.  
• The button you press will light*1 to specify that it is on,  
and that the note for all of the corresponding keyboard  
keys is lowered by one quarter tone.  
2. To return a note to its normal tuning, press the  
applicable button again so it becomes unlit  
(off).  
Example: To lower the E-note keys one quarter tone  
Lit*1  
E-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing with an Oriental Scale  
4. To return a note to its normal tuning, press the  
applicable button again so it becomes unlit  
(off).  
Fine Tuning Keyboard Keys  
(Scale Fine Tuning)  
You can use the procedure below to instantly fine tune the  
note assigned to all the keyboard keys that play it in 1 cent  
(1/100 semitone) steps.  
• Each press of a button toggles it between on (note is  
tuned) and off (normal tuning).  
• To return all 12 notes to their normal (equal  
temperament) tuning, select 01 (Equal Temperament)  
for the setting under “Selecting a Preset Scale” (page  
E-23).  
1. Use buttons D-6 (KEY C) through D-17 (KEY B)  
to specify the key whose note you want to fine  
tune. Hold down the button you want until the  
scale fine tuning screen shown below appear.  
Example: To fine tune the E-note keys  
• While the scale fine tuning screen is displayed, you can  
change the displayed note name by using the R-17 (t)  
button to select “Note”, and then the R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
scroll through note names. After selecting “Note” as  
described above, you also can specify a note by pressing a  
key on the keyboard.  
• You also can display the scale fine tuning screen from the  
scale screen. For details, see the “NOTE” under “Selecting  
a Preset Scale” (page E-23).  
Note name  
Selecting a Preset Scale  
Your Digital Keyboard comes with a number of different  
preset scales built in, including Rast, Bayati, Pythagorean  
system, and more. You can select the scale you want to use  
by performing the following simple steps.  
1. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-8 (SCALE) button to display  
the scale screen, with the 0 located at  
“Preset”.  
Current tuning value  
• The button you press will start flashing.  
2. Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to adjust  
the tuning value.  
• You can fine tune a note within in the range of –99  
through +99 cents. Play something on the keyboard to  
check the effect of your tuning.  
3. Press the button you pressed in step 1 (the one  
that is flashing).  
• This will exit the scale fine tuning screen and the button  
will change from flashing to lit, indicating that it is on.  
E-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing with an Oriental Scale  
2. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
4. Perform the following steps to specify the root  
• This displays a preset temperament selection screen  
like the one shown below.  
note of a temperament.  
(1)Press the R-17 (i) button.  
• This displays root note setting screen.  
3. Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to select a  
(2)Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
temperament.  
root note (C to B).  
• Selecting a temperament other than 01: Equal will  
cause the C indicator to appear on the display.  
• The following shows the temperament numbers and  
names that appear on the display.  
• You also can use the keyboard to specify the root  
note.  
While the scale screen is displayed, you can display the  
scale fine tuning screen by using the R-17 (y) button to  
select “Fine Tune” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
Number  
01  
Screen Name  
Equal  
Preset Temperament  
Equal temperament  
Just major intonation  
Just minor intonation  
Pythagorean system  
Kirnberger III  
Werckmeister 1-3 (III)  
Mean tone  
02  
Pure Major  
Pure Minor  
Pythagorean  
Kirnberger 3  
Werckmeister  
Mean-Tone  
Rast  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
Rast  
09  
Bayati  
Bayati  
10  
Hijaz  
Hijaz  
11  
Saba  
Saba  
12  
Dashti  
Dashti  
13  
Chahargah  
Segah  
Chahargah  
14  
Segah  
15  
Gurjari Todi  
Chandrakauns  
Charukeshi  
Gurjari Todi  
16  
Chandrakauns  
Charukeshi  
17  
E-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing with an Oriental Scale  
Saving Your Current Scale Setup  
(Scale Memory)  
You can use the following procedure to store up to four scale  
setups in memory for quick and easy recall whenever you  
want to use them.  
Specifying whether the Current  
Scale Settings Should be Applied  
to Auto Accompaniment  
(Accomp Scale)  
1. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-8 (SCALE) button to display  
the scale screen.  
1. While holding down the D-5 (STORE) button,  
press the SCALE MEMORY number button (D-1  
through D-4) to which you want to assign the  
current scale setup.  
2. Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
• This will save the current scale setup to the button you  
press.  
“AcmpScale”.  
• If there is a setup already assigned to the number key  
you press, it will be replaced (deleted) by the new  
setup.  
Example: To assign the current scale setup to the D-2 (2)  
button.  
3. Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to change  
the setting value.  
To do this:  
Select this setting:  
oFF  
Not apply scale settings to Auto  
Accompaniment  
Apply scale settings to Auto  
Accompaniment  
on  
2. To recall a saved scale setup, press the SCALE  
MEMORY number button (D-1 through D-4) to  
which it is assigned.  
4. When the setting is the way you want, press the  
R-15 (EXIT) button.  
• This will return to the screen that was displayed before  
you displayed the scale screen.  
• The above scale on/off setting affects all of the Auto  
Accompaniment chord parts (Chord 1 through Chord 5) and  
bass parts (A11 through A16). You also can turn scales  
settings on or off for each individual part using the Part  
Parameter (page E-43) “Scale (Part Scale Enable)” setting.  
E-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Auto Accompaniment  
C-4  
C-7  
R-15  
L-4  
-
L-9  
R-14  
L-11  
L-12  
R-17  
L-13  
L-14 L-16 L-18  
L-15 L-17  
R-18  
With Auto Accompaniment, simply select the accompaniment  
rhythm you want and the matching accompaniment (drums,  
guitar, etc.) will play automatically when you play a chord with  
your left hand. It’s like having your own personal backup  
group along with you wherever you go.  
3. Use the dial to scroll through the rhythm  
numbers until the one you want is displayed.  
Example: Group B, Number 005  
This Digital Keyboard has 250 built-in Auto Accompaniment  
patterns, which are divided into five groups. You can edit  
built-in rhythms to create your own original rhythms (called  
“user rhythms”), which you can save in a sixth group. For  
more information, see the separate “Appendix”.  
Playing an Auto Accompaniment  
1. Refer to the separate “Appendix” to look up the  
group and the number of the rhythm you want  
to use.  
Rhythm name  
Group  
Number  
• You also can use the R-14 (–, +) buttons to select a  
rhythm number. Holding down either button will scroll  
through rhythm numbers at high speed. Pressing both  
of the R-14 (–, +) buttons at the same time will select  
001 in the currently selected group.  
2. Use the buttons from L-4 ([A] POPS/ROCK/  
DANCE) to L-9 ([F] USER RHYTHMS) to select a  
rhythm group.  
• The L-9 ([F] USER RHYTHMS) button is for the user  
rhythm group. For details, see “Using the Pattern  
Sequencer” (page E-97).  
4. Use the L-11 (TEMPO w) and L-12 (TEMPO q)  
buttons to adjust the tempo setting.  
5. Press the L-18 (ACCOMP ON/OFF) button so the  
D indicator is on the display.  
• Each press of the button toggles accompaniment  
between on (D indicator displayed) and off  
(indicator not displayed).  
• All accompaniment instrument parts sound while  
accompaniment is on (D indicator displayed),  
while only percussion instrument parts (drums, etc.)  
sound while accompaniment is off (indicator not  
displayed).  
E-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Auto Accompaniment  
6. Press the L-16 (SYNCHRO/ENDING) button.  
10. When you are finished, press the L-17 (START/  
STOP) button again to stop Auto  
Accompaniment.  
• This enters synchro standby (Auto Accompaniment  
waiting for you to play a chord), with the F  
indicator flashing on the display. The flashing F  
indicator means that the normal Auto Accompaniment  
pattern is standing by.  
• Pressing the L-16 (SYNCHRO/ENDING) button instead  
of the L-17 (START/STOP) button will play an ending  
pattern before stopping Auto Accompaniment play. For  
details about ending patterns, see “Modifying Auto  
Accompaniment Patterns” (page E-29).  
7. You also can use the buttons described below  
to change to intro or variation pattern standby.  
To enter synchro  
Display  
standby for this  
pattern:  
Press this button:  
L-13 (INTRO)  
• You can use the following procedure to adjust the volume  
level of the Auto Accompaniment, without affecting the  
volume of Digital Keyboard output. For details, see  
“AccompVol. (Auto Accompaniment Volume)” (page  
E-128).  
• You can change the size of the chord keyboard by using  
the split feature to move the split point (page E-17). The  
keyboard keys to the left of the split point make up the  
chord keyboard.  
Indicator:  
Intro  
E
flashing  
Variation  
L-15 (VARIATION/  
FILL-IN)  
H
flashing  
For details about intro and variation patterns, see “Modifying  
Auto Accompaniment Patterns” (page E-29).  
8. Play the chord you want on the chord keyboard  
(left keyboard keys).  
• Auto Accompaniment will start playing when you play  
the chord.  
• To start percussion part play without playing a chord,  
press the L-17 (START/STOP) button.  
Example: To play a C chord  
Chord keyboard  
Melody keyboard  
• The chord root and type that corresponds to the keys  
you press appear in the chord area of the display.  
9. Play other chords with your left hand as you  
play the melody with your right hand.  
• You can use “CASIO Chord” or other simplified chord  
fingering modes to play chords. For details, see  
“Selecting a Chord Fingering Mode” in the following  
section.  
• You can use the L-14 (NORMAL/FILL-IN) and L-15  
(VARIATION/FILL-IN) buttons to modify  
accompaniment patterns. For details, see “Modifying  
Auto Accompaniment Patterns” (page E-29).  
E-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Auto Accompaniment  
Fingered 1, 2, 3  
Selecting a Chord Fingering Mode  
With these three chord fingering modes, you play chords on  
the chord keyboard using their normal chord fingerings. Some  
chord forms are abbreviated, and can be fingered with one or  
two keys. For information about the types of chords you can  
finger and their fingerings, see the “Fingering Guide” (page  
E-155).  
While Auto Accompaniment is playing, you use the chord  
keyboard to specify the chord root and type. The area of the  
keyboard to the left of the split point (page E-17) is the chord  
keyboard. The illustration below shows the chord keyboard  
range under AT-5 initial default settings.  
Fingered 1 : Play the component notes of the chord on the  
keyboard.  
Fingered 2 : Unlike Fingered 1, 6th input is not possible with  
this mode.  
Chord keyboard  
Melody Keyboard  
Fingered 3 : Unlike Fingered 1, this mode allows input of  
fraction chords with the lowest keyboard note as  
the bass note.  
You can select from among the following five chord fingering  
modes.  
CASIO Chord  
With “CASIO Chord”, you can use simplified fingerings to play  
the four types of chords described below.  
1: Fingered 1  
2: Fingered 2  
3: Fingered 3  
4: CASIO Chord  
5: Full Range  
Chord Type  
Major Chords  
Press one key, whose note  
corresponds to the chord  
name.  
Example  
C (C Major)  
CC#DEb E  
F
F#GAbABb  
B
CC#DEb E  
F
Note  
name  
To select a chord fingering mode  
• To play C Major, press any  
C key in the chord keyboard.  
The octave of the note does  
not matter.  
1. Hold down the L-18 (ACCOMP ON/OFF) button  
until the chord fingering mode selection screen  
shown below appears on the display.  
Minor Chords  
Cm (C minor)  
CC#DEb E  
F
F#GAbABb  
B
CC#DEb E  
F
Press the chord keyboard key  
that corresponds to the major  
chord, while also pressing one  
other chord keyboard key to  
the right.  
Seventh Chords  
C7 (C seventh)  
CC#DEb E  
F
F#GAbABb  
B
CC#DEb E  
F
Press the chord keyboard key  
that corresponds to the major  
chord, while also pressing two  
other chord keyboard keys to  
the right.  
Chord fingering mode  
Minor Seventh Chords  
Press the chord keyboard key  
that corresponds to the major  
chord, while also pressing  
three other chord keyboard  
keys to the right.  
Cm7 (C minor seventh)  
CC  
#DEb E  
F
F#GAbABb  
B
CC#DEb E  
F
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select a  
chord fingering mode.  
3. Press the L-18 (ACCOMP ON/OFF) button or the  
R-15 (EXIT) button.  
When pressing more than one chord keyboard key, it makes  
no difference whether the additional keys are white or black.  
• This exits the chord fingering mode selection screen.  
Full Range Chord  
With this chord fingering mode, you can use the full range of  
the keyboard to play chords and the melody. For information  
about the types of chords you can finger and their fingerings,  
see the “Fingering Guide” (page E-155).  
E-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Auto Accompaniment  
Modifying Auto Accompaniment  
Patterns  
There are six different Auto Accompaniment patterns, shown  
below. You can switch between patterns during  
Using One-Touch Presets  
One-Touch Preset gives you one-touch access to tone and  
tempo settings that go well with the currently selected Auto  
Accompaniment rhythm pattern.  
accompaniment play and even modify patterns. Use buttons  
L-13 through L-16 to select the pattern you want.  
To perform using a one-touch preset  
1. If rhythm is playing, press the L-17 (START/  
L-13  
L-14  
L-15  
L-16  
STOP) button to stop it.  
2. Select the rhythm (excluding user rhythms) you  
want to use.  
3. While holding down the L-8 ([E] PIANO  
RHYTHMS) button, press the L-9 ([F] USER  
RHYTHMS) button.  
Intro *1  
Normal  
Variation  
Ending *4  
Normal fill-in *2 Variation fill-in *3  
*1 Press at the beginning of a song. Accompaniment play  
proceeds with the normal pattern after the intro pattern is  
complete. Pressing the L-15 (VARIATION/FILL-IN) button  
before pressing this button will proceed with the variation  
pattern after the intro pattern is complete.  
• Settings for the following items are configured  
appropriately for the rhythm you selected in step 2.  
– Tones for the UPPER 1, UPPER 2, and LOWER  
parts  
– Octave shift for the UPPER 1, UPPER 2, and  
LOWER parts  
*2 Press while a normal pattern is playing to insert a fill-in  
pattern.  
– Layer and split on/off  
– Accompaniment on/off  
– Reverb on/off and type  
*3 Press while a variation pattern is playing to insert a fill-in  
variation pattern.  
– Chorus type  
– Auto harmonize or Arpeggiator on/off and type  
– Tempo  
*4 Press at the end of a song. This will play an ending pattern  
and then stop Auto Accompaniment.  
• Also, the F indicator flashes on the display to  
indicate that the normal Auto Accompaniment pattern is  
standing by.  
4. Start playing something on the keyboard.  
• Perform the procedure starting from step 7 under  
“Playing an Auto Accompaniment” (page E-26).  
• One-Touch Presets are not supported for user rhythms  
(F:001 through F:100).  
• You can recall one-touch preset settings even if a rhythm is  
already playing when you perform step 3 of the above  
procedure. In this case, rhythm play will continue without  
going into synchro standby.  
E-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Auto Accompaniment  
Type  
Number  
Type  
Name  
Using Auto Harmonize  
Description  
Auto harmonize lets you add harmony to melody notes you  
play with your right hand. You can select any one of 12 Auto  
harmonize settings.  
Adds 3-note open harmony, for a  
total of four notes.  
009  
010  
4WayOpen  
4WayClos  
Adds 3-note close harmony, for a  
total of four notes.  
To play using auto harmonize  
011  
012  
Block  
Adds block chord notes.  
1. Hold down the R-18 (AUTO HARMONIZE/  
ARPEGGIATOR) button until the type selection  
screen shown below appears on the display.  
Big Band  
Adds big band style harmony.  
• For information about type numbers greater than 012,  
see “Playing Arpeggio Phrases Automatically  
(Arpeggiator)” (page E-21).  
3. Press the R-15 (EXIT) button.  
• This exits the type selection screen.  
4. Press the R-18 (AUTO HARMONIZE/  
ARPEGGIATOR) button.  
• This causes a pointer indicator to appear on the display  
next to AUTO HARMONIZE.  
Lit  
Type number  
Type name  
5. Play chords and the melody on the keyboard.  
• Harmony will be added to your melody notes based on  
the chords you play.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select the  
auto harmonize type you want to use.  
6. To turn off auto harmonize, press the R-18  
(AUTO HARMONIZE/ARPEGGIATOR) button  
again.  
• You can select one of the type numbers (001 through  
012) described in the table below.  
Type  
Type  
• This causes the pointer indicator next to AUTO  
HARMONIZE to disappear.  
Description  
Number  
Name  
Adds close (separated by two to  
four degrees) one-note harmony  
below the melody note.  
001  
002  
Duet 1  
Adds open (separated by more  
than 4 to 6 degrees) 1-note  
Duet 2  
harmony below the melody note.  
003  
004  
005  
006  
Country  
Octave  
5th  
Adds country style harmony.  
Adds the note from the next lower  
octave.  
Adds the fifth degree note.  
Adds 2-note open harmony, for a  
total of three notes.  
3WayOpen  
Adds 2-note close harmony, for a  
total of three notes.  
007  
008  
3WayClos  
Strings  
Adds harmony that is optimal for  
strings.  
E-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Applying Effects to a Sound  
You can apply a variety of different acoustic effects to the sounds produced by the Digital Keyboard. The built-in effects include a  
wide variety of variations that give you access to a selection of general digital effects.  
• The Digital Keyboard also lets you apply effects to input from the T-5 (INST IN) jack and T-8 (MIC IN) jack.  
Configuration of Effects  
The following shows how Digital Keyboard effects are configured.  
• Items such as “Reverb Send” that are indicated by the symbol  
(page E-38).  
are all mixer settings. For details, see “Using the Mixer”  
• Chorus and DSP cannot be used at the same time.  
Chorus Effect Mode Configuration  
The chorus effect mode is enabled while “Chorus” is selected for the “Chorus/DSP” effect parameter. Chorus and reverb can be  
used in the chorus effect mode.  
Part A01-A16, B01-B16  
Output  
Part Volume/Pan  
Reverb Send  
Master  
Volume/Pan  
Tone Generator  
Reverb  
Chorus  
Chorus Send  
External Input  
Volume/Pan  
Mic In  
Inst In  
Auto Level  
Control  
Reverb Send  
Chorus Send  
Noise Gate  
Mono  
Stereo  
• For information about “Chorus/DSP”, see “Selecting an Effect” (page E-33).  
E-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Applying Effects to a Sound  
DSP Effect Mode Configuration  
The DSP effect mode is enabled while “DSP” is selected for the “Chorus/DSP”effect parameter. DSP and reverb can be used in the  
DSP effect mode.  
Part A01-A16, B01-B16  
Output  
Part Volume/Pan  
Off  
DSP  
Master  
Tone Generator  
Volume/Pan  
Reverb Send  
On  
Reverb  
DSP Reverb Send  
External Input  
Volume/Pan  
DSP  
DSP Volume/Pan  
Mic In  
Inst In  
Off  
On  
DSP  
Noise  
Gate  
AutoLevel  
Control  
Reverb Send  
Mono  
Stereo  
• Reverb  
This type of effect simulates acoustic spaces. There are 10 different reverb effects, including room and hall.  
• Chorus  
This type of effect increases the depth of notes and applies vibrato to notes. There are five different chorus effects.  
• DSP  
This type of effect is inserted between the sound source and output. There are a total of 100 different DSP effects, including  
distortion and modulation. You also can transfer DSP effects from a computer or create DSP data on the Digital Keyboard, and  
store up to 100 user DSP effects in Digital Keyboard memory. For details, see “Creating a User DSP” (page E-35) and  
“Connecting to a Computer” (page E-140).  
E-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Applying Effects to a Sound  
C-7  
R-13  
R-14  
R-15  
R-16  
R-17  
Selecting an Effect  
Effects are divided among different types (reverb, chorus,  
DSP), so first you need to use the procedure below to select  
an effect type.  
• A pointer indicator is displayed next to REVERB when  
anything other than “oFF” is selected for the reverb type.  
The pointer indicator is not displayed next to REVERB  
when “oFF” is selected.  
• You can use Reverb Send to adjust how reverb is applied  
to the tone of each keyboard or Auto Accompaniment part.  
For details, see “Using the Mixer” (page E-38).  
To add reverb to sounds  
1. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-7 (EFFECT) button.  
To add the chorus effect to sounds  
1. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-7 (EFFECT) button to  
display the effect setting screen.  
• This displays the effect setting screen shown below.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select the  
reverb type you want to use.  
• Refer to the separate “Appendix” for information about  
supported reverb types.  
• To turn off reverb, select “oFF” here.  
3. Press the C-7 (EFFECT) button or the R-15  
(EXIT) button.  
• This exits the effect setting screen.  
E-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Applying Effects to a Sound  
2. If you want, use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to  
move the thick brackets (%) to the “DSP  
Disable”setting, and then use the R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to change the setting to “on”.  
8. Use the mixer to adjust the chorus send of the  
part to which you want to apply chorus.  
• You can use “Cho.Send” (Part Chorus Send, page  
E-43) to adjust how chorus is applied to the tone of  
each keyboard or Auto Accompaniment part. The initial  
default setting is 0 for the chorus send of all parts, so  
change the settings to a chorus send value greater than  
0 for all parts to which you want to apply the chorus  
effect. For details, see “Using the Mixer” (page E-38).  
• For more information about this setting, see the  
“Important!” note below.  
• If you turning on the “DSP Disable” setting, you should  
skip steps 3 and 4 below.  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the thick  
brackets (%) to the “Chorus/DSP” setting.  
• Selecting a tone with DSP causes the “Chorus/DSP”  
setting to change automatically to the “DSP” (DSP  
effect mode), so the chorus effect will not be available.  
If you want the chorus effect always to be available,  
change the “DSP Disable” setting to “on”. This will  
keep the Digital Keyboard in the chorus effect mode.  
4. Use the R-14 (–, +) buttons to select “Chorus”.  
• This enters the chorus effect mode, which enables the  
use of the chorus effect.  
5. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the thick  
brackets (%) to the “Chorus” setting.  
• A pointer indicator is displayed next to CHORUS when  
“Chorus” is selected for the “Chorus/DSP” setting. The  
pointer indicator is not displayed next to CHORUS when  
“oFF” is selected for the chorus type or when “DSP” is  
selected for the “Chorus/DSP” setting.  
• Selecting “Chorus” for the “Chorus/DSP” setting will cause  
the “DSP Line” (Part DSP Line, page E-43) setting for all  
parts to be changed to “oFF”.  
To use a DSP  
6. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select the  
chorus type you want to use.  
1. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-7 (EFFECT) button to  
display the effect setting screen.  
• Refer to the separate “Appendix” for information about  
supported chorus types.  
7. Press the C-7 (EFFECT) button or the R-15  
(EXIT) button.  
• This exits the effect setting screen.  
• Check to make sure that the “DSP Disable” setting is  
“oFF”. If it is “on”, change it to “oFF”.  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the thick  
brackets (%) to “Chorus/DSP”.  
3. Use the R-14 (–, +) buttons to select “DSP”.  
• This enters the DSP effect mode, which enables the  
use of the DSP effect.  
E-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Applying Effects to a Sound  
4. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the thick  
brackets (%) to the “DSP” setting.  
Creating a User DSP  
• This causes the number and name of the currently  
selected preset DSP to appear within the thick brackets  
(%) on the display.  
You can create a user DSP by editing one of the built-in  
preset DSPs.  
User DSP Numbers  
DSP areas numbered 101 through 200 are for storage of user  
DSPs. You can have up to 100 user DSPs stored in memory  
at one time. To recall a stored user DSP, use the same  
procedure you use to recall a preset DSP. See “To use a  
DSP” (page E-34) for more information.  
To create and save a user DSP  
1. Referring to the “DSP Type List” (page E-151),  
select the DSP type you want to edit in order to  
create your user DSP.  
5. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select the  
preset DSP you want to use.  
• DSPs with the leading numbers 001 through 100 (and  
“ton”) are preset DSPs. See “Preset DSP List” on page  
E-150 for information about preset DSP numbers and  
names.  
2. Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to “DSP  
Edit”.  
• DSP types with the leading numbers 101 through 200  
are user DSPs. For details, see “Creating a User DSP”  
(page E-35).  
6. Press the C-7 (EFFECT) button or the R-15  
(EXIT) button.  
• This exits the effect setting screen.  
• A pointer indicator is displayed next to DSP when “DSP” is  
selected for the “Chorus/DSP” setting.  
3. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This displays page one of the DSP editor screen. Use  
this screen to select the DSP type.  
• Maximum polyphony is reduced by a maximum of two  
notes when playing on the keyboard while a DSP is in use.  
• You also can adjust how a DSP is applied (DSP output  
enabled/disabled, DSP output volume, DSP output pan,  
etc.) For details, see “Using the Mixer” (page E-38).  
Total number of pages  
Currently displayed page  
DSP type  
DSP number  
• You can use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to scroll  
between pages.  
4. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select a  
DSP type.  
E-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Applying Effects to a Sound  
5. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
10. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select the  
the parameter you want to change.  
destination user DSP number you want.  
11. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the  
cursor to the name character position you want  
to change, and then use the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to select the character you want.  
• See “Supported Input Characters” (page E-155) for  
information about the characters you can input for the  
name.  
• To input a space, press both of the R-14 (–, +) buttons  
at the same time.  
• For information about the operation and the setting  
range of each parameter, see “DSP Parameter  
Settings” (page E-37).  
12. After everything is the way you want, press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
6. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
• A message (Replace?) will appear on the display to  
confirm whether you want to replace the existing data  
with the new data. Press the R-14 (YES) button to  
replace the existing data with the new data.  
setting value.  
• Pressing the R-14 (–, +) buttons at the same time  
returns a parameter to its initial default setting.  
• Changing the DSP parameter while a note is being  
output from the Digital Keyboard may cause noise to be  
generated. This does not indicate malfunction.  
• The message “Please Wait” will remain on the display  
while a data save operation is in progress. Do not  
perform any other operation while it is displayed.  
Turning off the Digital Keyboard or removing the  
memory card can cause Digital Keyboard data to be  
deleted or become corrupted. It also can cause the  
Digital Keyboard to fail to turn on when the L-1  
(POWER) button is pressed. If this happens, refer to  
“Troubleshooting” (page E-145).  
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 as required to configure  
other parameters.  
8. Press the R-15 (EXIT) button.  
• This displays the confirmation screen shown below.  
To cancel the editor operation without saving the edited  
results, press the R-14 (NO) button.  
9. Press the R-14 (YES) button.  
• This displays a screen for specifying the destination  
user DSP number and DSP name.  
Destination user DSP number  
DSP name  
E-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Applying Effects to a Sound  
DSP Parameter Settings  
The table below shows the parameters that can be configured on the DSP editor screen.  
The settings marked with an asterisk (*) in the “Setting Range” column are initial defaults.  
Parameter Name  
Description  
Setting Range  
Parameters 1 through 8  
The number of parameters and settings available for each parameter  
depends on the DSP type. For details, see “DSP Parameter List” (page  
E-152).  
DSP RevSend  
Specifies how much of the post-DSP sound should be sent to reverb.  
0 - 40* - 127  
(DSP Reverb Send)  
Mod Button Assign*1  
(Modulation Button Assign)  
Specifies the function assigned to the S-2 (MODULATION) button when oFF*, 1 - 8*2  
“DSP” is selected for the “Mod Setting” tone parameter (page E-48).  
Specifying a value from 1 through 8 assigns the corresponding DSP  
parameter (1 through 8). Nothing is assigned to the button when “oFF” is  
selected for this parameter.  
*3  
Mod Button On Value*1  
Specifies how the function currently assigned to the S-2  
(Modulation Button On Value)  
(MODULATION) button works while the button is depressed.  
*3  
Mod Button Off Value*1  
Specifies how the function currently assigned to the S-2  
(Modulation Button Off Value)  
(MODULATION) button works while the button is released.  
*1 Included in the “Mod Button” group. To change the settings of these parameters, move the 0 to “Mod Button” and then press  
the R-16 (ENTER) button. Next, use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to the parameter whose setting you want to  
change.  
*2 Setting range depends on the selected DSP type.  
*3 Depends on the selected DSP type and the “Mod Button Assign” setting.  
E-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Mixer  
C-7  
R-13  
R-14  
R-15  
R-16  
R-17  
C-17  
This  
part:  
Go here for more  
information:  
Mixer Overview  
Is used for this:  
The sound source of this Digital Keyboard is capable of  
sounding up to 32 individual parts simultaneously. Each part  
can be controlled individually, and each part can be  
configured to sound a different musical instrument. Different  
tones can be assigned to each part when using layer and split  
to sound multiple tones at the same time, and to sound  
multiple instruments at the same time with Auto  
Auto Accompaniment  
percussion part  
“Using Auto  
Accompaniment” (page  
E-26)  
A09  
Auto Accompaniment drums  
part  
A10  
A11  
Auto Accompaniment bass  
part  
Accompaniment.  
A12to Auto Accompaniment Chord  
A16 1 part through Chord 5 part  
The mixer can be used to assign such tones and to configure  
other settings for each part, and to configure global effect  
settings applied to all parts. The mixer provides you with the  
means to make fine adjustments to a wide variety of settings,  
from note generation to note output.  
“Using the Song  
Sequencer” (page  
Song sequencer track B01  
through B16, tracks 1 through E-63), “Playing a Music  
B01to 16 during playback of a MIDI File from a Memory  
B16 file from a memory card, CH1 Card” (page E-137),  
through CH16 during MIDI  
receive  
“Connecting to a  
Computer” (page  
E-140)  
How Parts are Organized  
This Digital Keyboard has a total of 32 parts: A01 through  
A16, and B01 through B16. Each part has a specific purpose.  
Use the table below as a reference to determine the purpose  
of each part when using the mixer to configure the settings of  
a part.  
*1 UPPER 1 part recorded to the song sequencer system  
track.  
*2 UPPER 2 part recorded to the song sequencer system  
track.  
This  
part:  
Go here for more  
information:  
Is used for this:  
*3 LOWER part recorded to the song sequencer system  
track.  
A01 Manual play UPPER 1 part  
A02 Manual play UPPER 2 part  
A03 Manual play LOWER part  
“Layering and Splitting  
Tones” (page E-15)  
“Using Auto  
Harmonize” (page  
E-30)  
A04 Auto harmonize tone  
A05 UPPER 1 part*1  
A06 UPPER 2 part*2  
A07 LOWER part*3  
“Using the Song  
Sequencer” (page  
E-63)  
“Using the Metronome”  
(page E-19)  
A08 Metronome sound  
E-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Mixer  
• When you move the thick brackets (%) to one of the  
setting values of a part parameter, all of the part  
parameter values of the Group (A or B) to which the  
part belongs are indicated by level meter black boxes.  
Mixer Operation  
To change mixer parameters  
1. Press the C-7 (MIXER) button.  
• This causes the mixer screen to appear.  
4. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting value.  
Currently selected setting  
(MASTER, DSP, MIC/INST, or A01 to A16/B01 to B16)  
• Pressing the R-14 (–, +) buttons at the same time  
returns a parameter to its initial default setting.  
• While the “Part” (part on/off) setting of a part parameter  
is being configured, pressing both of the R-14 (–, +)  
buttons at the same time will change the setting to “Sol”  
(Solo). For details, see “Part Parameters” (page E-43).  
5. Repeat steps 2 through 4 as required to  
configure other parameters.  
Parameter/Setting value  
6. To exit the mixer, press the C-7 (MIXER) button  
or the R-15 (EXIT) button.  
Currently selected setting part  
(when currently selected setting is A01 to A16/B01 to B16)  
• This exits the mixer screen.  
2. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to select the  
mixer parameter you want to change.  
• While master (MASTER), effect (DSP) or microphone input  
(MIC/INST) is selected in step 2 above for setting, you also  
can perform normal keyboard play (play using layer, split,  
and Auto Accompaniment).  
• While an individual part (A01 through A16, B01 through  
B16) is selected in step 2 above for setting, pressing a  
keyboard key will sound only notes of the selected part. All  
other types of performance operations (layer, split, Auto  
Accompaniment, etc.) are disabled.  
• You can select master (MASTER), effect (DSP),  
microphone input (MIC/INST), or a part (A01 through  
A16, B01 through B16). The currently selected setting  
is shown in the line two of the display.  
• While a part is selected, you can toggle between Group  
A and Group B by pressing both of the R-17 (u, i)  
buttons at the same time.  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the thick  
brackets (%) to the parameter you want to  
change.  
• The parameters that can be configured depend on the  
currently selected setting. For details, refer to the  
sections shown in the table below.  
When this setting is  
selected:  
These parameters can be  
configured:  
MASTER  
MASTER parameters  
(page E-41)  
MIC/INST  
MIC/INST parameters  
(page E-42)  
DSP  
DSP parameters (page E-41)  
Part parameters (page E-43)  
A01 to A16/B01 to B16  
E-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Mixer  
To initialize all mixer parameters  
To change the information displayed by the  
level meter while configuring part parameter  
settings  
• For details about how initial default settings are configured  
when you perform the following procedure, see “Parameter  
List” (page E-158).  
1. While the mixer screen is displayed, hold down  
the R-13 (FUNCTION) button as you press the  
C-17 (MENU) button.  
1. While the mixer screen is displayed, hold down  
the R-13 (FUNCTION) button as you press the  
C-17 (MENU) button.  
• This displays the mixer menu.  
2. Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
“Display” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays the mixer menu screen with the 0 next to  
“Initialize”.  
3. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting.  
To select display of this  
Select this setting:  
information:  
Part parameter setting values  
Volume level  
Param  
Meter  
4. After the setting is the way you want, press the  
2. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
R-15 (EXIT) button to exit the menu.  
3. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to  
initialize all mixer parameters or the R-14 (NO)  
button to cancel.  
E-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Mixer  
Mixer Parameter Settings  
The tables below show the parameters that can be configured on the mixer screen.  
The settings marked with an asterisk (*) in the “Setting Range” column are initial defaults.  
MASTER Parameters  
MASTER parameters include items for adjusting the volume level, pan position, and other settings that are applied globally to all  
parts.  
Parameter Name  
Volume  
Description  
Setting Range  
0 to 127*  
Specifies the maximum volume level of Digital Keyboard output.  
The level set here is the maximum level that can be set with the L-2 (MAIN  
VOLUME) knob.  
(Master Volume)  
Pan  
(Master Pan)  
Specifies the stereo pan position of all sound output by the Digital Keyboard.  
0 indicates the center, while a smaller values shifts to the left and a larger value  
shifts to the right.  
–64 to 0* to +63  
DSP Parameters  
DSP parameters include DSP-related settings that are applied globally to all parts.  
• DSP parameter setting cannot be changed while “on” is selected for the “DSP Disable” effect setting. See “To add the  
chorus effect to sounds” (page E-33) for information about “DSP Disable”. If you want to change DSP parameter  
settings, change the “DSP Disable” setting to “oFF”.  
Parameter Name  
Cho/DSP  
Description  
Setting Range  
Chorus*, DSP  
Specifies whether the Digital Keyboard’s sound source should go through  
the chorus or DSP.*1 This setting item is linked to the “Chorus/DSP”*2 item  
on the effect setting screen. The settings below cannot be configured  
whenever this parameter is “Chorus”.  
(Chorus/DSP)  
Part  
Specifies if a note should be output (on) or not output (oFF) after it passes  
through the DSP.  
oFF, on*  
(DSP Output Enable)  
Volume  
Specifies the post-DSP volume level.*1  
0 to 127*  
(DSP Output Volume)  
Pan  
Specifies the post-DSP send stereo pan position. 0 indicates the center,  
while a smaller values shifts to the left and a larger value shifts to the right.  
–64 to 0* to +63  
0 to 40* to 127  
(DSP Output Pan)  
Rev.Send  
Specifies how much reverb is applied to the post-DSP send note.  
(DSP Output Reverb Send)  
*1 See the block diagram under “Configuration of Effects” (page E-31).  
*2 See “To add the chorus effect to sounds” (page E-33) and “To use a DSP” (page E-34).  
E-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Mixer  
MIC/INST Parameters  
MIC/INST parameters include settings related to the T-5 (INST IN) and T-8 (MIC IN) terminals.  
Parameter Name  
Description  
Setting Range  
Part  
Specifies if sound input should be output (on) or not output (oFF).  
oFF, on*  
(Mic/Inst Enable)  
Volume  
Specifies the volume level of sound input.  
0 to 80* to 127  
(Mic/Inst Volume)*1  
Pan  
(Mic/Inst Pan)  
Specifies the stereo pan position of sound input. 0 indicates the center, while a –64 to 0* to +63  
smaller values shifts to the left and a larger value shifts to the right.  
DSP Line  
(Mic/Inst DSP Line)  
Specifies whether DSP should be applied to sound input.  
Specifies how much reverb is applied to sound input.  
Specifies how much chorus effect is applied to sound input.  
oFF*, on  
Rev.Send  
(Mic/Inst Reverb Send)  
0 to 40* to 127  
0* to 127  
Cho.Send  
(Mic/Inst Chorus Send)  
N.Thresh  
Cuts low-volume input sounds, which decreases noise. Allows a signal to pass 0 to 20* to 127  
through if it is above the set threshold (gate open). Does not allow a signal to  
pass if it is below the threshold (gate closed).  
(Mic/Inst Noise Gate  
Threshold)*1  
N.Release  
Specifies the amount of time for the gate to go from open to fully closed when an 0 to 64* to 127  
input sound signal falls below the threshold value specified by “N.Thresh”.  
Setting 0 will abruptly cut off the sound, while a larger value will cause the gate  
to close more slowly.  
(Mic/Inst Noise Gate  
Release)*1  
Auto Level  
Automatically controls the input signal level. Selecting “oFF” disables this  
feature, while a larger value applies a greater degree of control.  
oFF*, 1 to 3  
(Mic/Inst Auto Level  
Control)*1  
*1 See the block diagram under “Configuration of Effects” (page E-31).  
B
E-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Mixer  
Part Parameters  
Part parameters include setting items that can be adjusted for parts A01 through A16 and B01 through B16.  
Parameter Name  
TONE  
Description  
Setting Range  
Specifies a tone for each part. When configuring this parameter, you can use the  
A:001 to L:100  
(Part Tone)  
buttons R-1 ([A] PIANO) through R-12 ([L] USER TONES) to select a tone group.  
Part  
(Part On/Off)  
Specifies if the notes of a particular part should be output (on) or not output (oFF).  
When a part is turned on, the part number is displayed along the bottom of the level  
meter. Part numbers are not displayed for parts that are turned off.  
When playing back a MIDI file or song sequencer song, a “Sol” (Solo) option can be  
specified to play a specific part only. To switch to “Sol”, press both R-14 (–, +)  
buttons at the same time.  
oFF, on*  
Volume  
Specifies the volume level of each part.  
0 to 127*  
(Part Volume)  
Pan  
(Part Pan)  
Specifies the stereo pan position of each part. 0 indicates the center, while a smaller –64 to 0* to +63  
values shifts to the left and a larger value shifts to the right.  
CoarseTune  
(Part Coarse Tune)  
Specifies, in semitone steps, the pitch of the notes of each part.  
Specifies, in cent steps, the pitch of the notes of each part.  
Specifies the bend range of each part.  
–24 to 0* to +24  
–99 to 0* to +99  
0 to 2* to 24  
FineTune  
(Part Fine Tune)  
BendRange  
(Part Bend Range)  
DSP Line  
(Part DSP Line)  
Specifies whether DSP should be applied to each part. Changing this setting from  
“oFF” to “on” automatically switches the “Cho/DSP” setting (page E-41) to “DSP”.  
oFF*, on  
Rev.Send  
(Part Reverb Send)  
Specifies how much reverb is applied to each part.  
No reverb is applied at all when this setting is 0, while maximum reverb is applied  
when it is 127.  
0 to 40* to 127  
Cho.Send  
(Part Chorus Send)  
Specifies how much chorus is applied to each part.  
No chorus is applied at all when this setting is 0, while maximum chorus is applied  
when it is 127.  
0* to 127  
Scale  
(Part Scale Enable)  
Specifies whether scale (page E-22) settings should be applied (on) or should not be oFF*, on  
applied (oFF). Equal temperament is applied to parts when this setting is “oFF”.  
B
E-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Tone Editor  
C-8  
R-13  
R-14  
R-15  
R-16  
R-17  
C-17  
You can create a user tone by editing one of the built-in preset  
tones.  
(1) Tone Characteristic Waveform  
• Tone Setting  
Specifies which of the preset tones should be used as the  
original tone.  
Tone Creation Overview  
The preset tones built into this Digital Keyboard consist of a  
number of parameters. To create a user tone, you first recall a  
preset tone (A:001 through K:128) and then modify its  
parameters to change it to your own original tone.  
Note that drum set sounds (K:129 through K:147) cannot be  
used as the basis of a user tone.  
The illustration nearby shows the parameters that make up  
the preset tones, and what each parameter does. As can be  
seen in the illustration, parameters can be divided into four  
groups, each of which is described in detail below.  
(2) Volume Characteristic Parameters  
These parameters control how the tone changes over time,  
from when the keyboard key is pressed until the tone decays.  
You can specify changes in volume and sound  
characteristics.  
• Attack time  
This is the rate or time it takes for the tone to reach its highest  
volume level. You can specify a fast rate, where the tone  
reaches its highest volume level immediately, a slow rate  
where it gradually rises, or something in between.  
• Release time  
Volume Characteristic  
Parameters  
This is the rate or time it takes for the tone volume to fall to  
zero after a keyboard key is released. You can specify a  
release that ranges from a sudden fall to zero, to one that  
gradually falls to zero.  
• Attack Time  
• Release Time  
• Cutoff Frequency  
Tone Pitch Parameters  
Tone  
Characteristic  
Waveform  
• Vibrato Type  
• Vibrato Depth  
• Vibrato Rate  
• Vibrato Delay  
• Octave Shift  
Note ends  
Envelope  
Output  
• Tone  
Setting  
Tone Characteristic  
Setting Parameters  
Time  
A
R
• Volume  
• Touch Sense  
• Reverb Send  
• Chorus Send  
• DSP Line  
Key pressed  
Key released  
A : Attack time  
R : Release time  
• DSP Type  
• DSP Parameters  
E-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Tone Editor  
• Cutoff Frequency  
Creating a User Tone  
The cutoff frequency is a parameter for adjusting timbre by  
cutting any frequency that is higher than a specific frequency.  
A larger cutoff frequency produces a brighter (harder) timbre,  
while a smaller frequency produces a darker (softer) timbre.  
User Tone Numbers  
Tone areas numbered L:001 through L:100 are for storage of  
user tones. You can have up to 100 user tones stored in  
memory at one time. You can recall a stored user tone by  
pressing the R-12 ([L] USER TONES) button. See “To select  
a tone” (page E-14).  
Level  
To create and save a user tone  
Frequency  
1. Select the tone you want to edit in order to  
create your user tone.  
Cutoff frequency  
2. Press the C-8 (TONE EDITOR) button.  
(3) Tone Pitch Parameters  
• Vibrato Type, Vibrato Delay, Vibrato Rate, Vibrato  
Depth  
These parameters adjust the vibrato effect, which causes  
periodic changes in the tone.  
• Octave Shift  
This parameter controls the octave of all tones.  
• This displays the tone editor screen.  
Total number of pages  
(4) Tone Characteristic Setting Parameters  
Currently displayed page  
• Volume  
This parameter controls the overall volume of the tone.  
• Touch Sense  
This parameter controls changes in volume and timbre in  
accordance with the relative amount of pressure applied to  
the keyboard keys. You can specify more volume for stronger  
pressure and less volume or a lighter pressure, or you can  
specify the same volume regardless of how much pressure is  
applied to the keys.  
• Reverb Send, Chorus Send, DSP Line , DSP Type, DSP  
Parameters  
These parameters control the effects applied to tones.  
Parameter name  
Current setting  
Currently selected parameter  
(Enclosed by thick brackets %).  
• You can use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to scroll  
between pages.  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
the parameter you want to change.  
• For information about the operation and the setting  
range of each parameter, see “Tone Parameter  
Settings” (page E-47).  
B
E-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Tone Editor  
4. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting value.  
• Pressing the R-14 (–, +) buttons at the same time  
returns a parameter to its initial default setting.  
• The message “Please Wait” will remain on the display  
while a data save operation is in progress. Do not  
perform any other operation while it is displayed.  
Turning off the Digital Keyboard or removing the  
memory card can cause Digital Keyboard data to be  
deleted or become corrupted. It also can cause the  
Digital Keyboard to fail to turn on when the L-1  
(POWER) button is pressed. If this happens, refer to  
“Troubleshooting” (page E-145).  
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 as required to configure  
other parameters.  
6. To save a rhythm after you edit it, hold down  
the R-13 (FUNCTION) button as you press the  
C-17 (MENU) button.  
• This displays the tone editor menu.  
• Pressing the R-15 (EXIT) button in place of step 6 displays  
the confirmation screen shown below. Pressing the R-14  
(YES) button at this time will display the tone save screen in  
step 7.  
7. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This displays a screen for specifying the destination  
user tone number and tone name.  
Destination user tone number  
To cancel the editor operation without saving the edited  
results, press the R-14 (NO) button.  
Tone name  
8. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select the  
destination user tone number you want.  
9. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the  
cursor to the name character position you want  
to change, and then use the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to select the character you want.  
• See “Supported Input Characters” (page E-155) for  
information about the characters you can input for the  
name.  
• To input a space, press both of the R-14 (–, +) buttons  
at the same time.  
10. After everything is the way you want, press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• A message (Replace?) will appear on the display to  
confirm whether you want to replace the existing data  
with the new data. Press the R-14 (YES) button to  
replace the existing data with the new data.  
E-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Tone Editor  
Tone Parameter Settings  
The table below shows the parameters that can be configured on the tone editor screen. For information about each parameter,  
also refer to “Tone Creation Overview” (page E-44).  
The settings marked with an asterisk (*) in the “Setting Range” column are initial defaults.  
Parameter Name  
AttackTime  
Description  
Setting Range  
–64 to 0* to +63  
Specifies the time until a note starts to sound after a key is pressed.  
(Attack Time)  
ReleasTime  
(Release Time)  
Specifies the time a note continues to sound after a key is released.  
–64 to 0* to +63  
–64 to 0* to +63  
CutOff  
(Cutoff Frequency)  
Adjusts timbre by attenuating note components that are higher than a certain  
frequency. A larger value produces a brighter, harder sound, while a lower  
value produces a mellower, softer sound.  
Vib.Type  
Specifies the vibrato type (vibrato waveform).  
Sin*, Tri, Saw, Sqr  
(Vibrato Type)  
Setting  
Sin  
Description  
Sine wave  
Waveform  
Tri  
Triangle wave  
Sawtooth wave  
Square wave  
Saw  
Sqr  
Vib.Depth  
(Vibrato Depth)  
Specifies how much vibrato is applied to a note.  
Specifies the speed of the vibrato applied to a note.  
Specifies how much time elapses until vibrato starts.  
–64 to 0* to +63  
–64 to 0* to +63  
–64 to 0* to +63  
–2 to 0* to +2  
0 to 127*  
Vib.Rate  
(Vibrato Rate)  
Vib.Delay  
(Vibrato Delay)  
Oct.Shift  
(Octave Shift)  
Shifts the pitch upwards or downwards in octave steps.  
Volume  
(Volume)  
Specifies the volume level of all tones. A larger value sets a higher volume  
level.  
TouchSense  
(Touch Sense)  
Specifies how much the volume changes in accordance with the relative  
amount of pressure applied to keyboard keys. A larger positive value results  
more change in volume in accordance with key pressure. A larger negative  
values results in less change in volume in accordance with key pressure. Key  
pressure does not affect volume when a value of 0 is set.  
–64 to 0 to +63*  
Rev.Send  
(Reverb Send)  
Specifies how much reverb is applied for each tone.  
0 to 40* to 127  
0* to 127  
Cho.Send  
Specifies how much chorus is applied for each tone.  
(Chorus Send)  
DSP On Off  
(DSP On/Off)  
Specifies whether DSP should be applied (on) or not applied (oFF) to notes.  
The following four settings become enabled when “on” is selected for this  
setting.  
oFF*, on  
DSP  
Specifies the DSP to be applied to tones using DSP numbers (001 to 100:  
Preset DSPs; 101 to 200: User DSPs). Selecting “ton” applies the initial preset  
DSP of each tone.  
ton*, 001 to 200  
DSP Type  
(DSP Type)  
Shows the DSP type number corresponding to the above DSP value that is set 01 to 46*1  
automatically as the initial default setting.*1 You can modify the initial default  
setting and select a different DSP type.  
E-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Tone Editor  
Parameter Name  
Description  
Setting Range  
*2  
DSP Parameters 1  
through 8  
Shows up to eight parameters for “DSP Type”. *2  
DSP RevSend  
(DSP Reverb Send)  
Adjusts how much reverb is applied to the post-DSP note.  
Assigns either vibrato or DSP to the S-2 (MODULATION) button.  
0 to 40* to 127  
Vib*, DSP  
Mod Setting  
(Modulation Setting)  
Mod Depth  
(Modulation Depth)  
When vibrato is assigned to the S-2 (MODULATION) button, specifies the  
depth of vibrato applied to a tone while the button is depressed.  
0 to 127 (Default  
setting depends on  
the tone.)  
Mod Button Assign*3  
(Modulation Button  
Assign)  
Specifies the function assigned to the S-2 (MODULATION) button when “DSP” oFF*, 1 to 8*4  
is selected for the “Mod Setting”. Specifying a value from 1 through 8 assigns  
the corresponding DSP parameter (1 through 8). Nothing is assigned to the  
button when “oFF” is selected for this parameter.  
*5  
Mod Button On Value*3  
(Modulation Button On  
Value)  
Specifies how the function currently assigned to the S-2 (MODULATION)  
button works while the button is depressed.  
*5  
Mod Button Off Value*3  
(Modulation Button Off  
Value)  
Specifies how the function currently assigned to the S-2 (MODULATION)  
button works while the button is released.  
*1 See “Preset DSP List” (page E-150) for information about the DSP types of each preset DSP.  
*2 The number of DSP parameters, their content, and their setting ranges depend on the DSP type. For details, see “DSP Type  
List” (page E-151) and “DSP Parameter List” (page E-152).  
*3 Included in the “Mod Button” group. To change the settings of these parameters, move the 0 to “Mod Button” and then press  
the R-16 (ENTER) button. Next, use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to the parameter whose setting you want to  
change.  
*4 Setting range depends on the selected DSP type.  
*5 Depends on the selected DSP type and the “Mod Button Assign” setting.  
E-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Music Presets  
R-15  
L-4  
-
L-9  
R-1  
-
R-12  
R-16  
R-17  
R-14  
L-14 L-16 L-18  
L-15 L-17  
C-10  
C-17  
R-13  
To perform using a music preset  
Using Music Presets  
1. Refer to the separate “Appendix” to find the  
music preset you want to use, and note its  
group and number.  
Music presets provide one-touch access to Auto  
Accompaniment, tone, reverb, and other settings that are  
configured in accordance with preset chord progressions. A  
total of 305 presets let you easily configure the keyboard for a  
wide variety of different musical styles. Chord progressions  
include both short loops of a few measures that are great for  
improvisation, as well as progressions for entire songs. Chord  
progressions are also fun just to listen to.  
2. While holding down the L-7 ([D] ARABIC/  
ORIENTAL) button, press the L-8 ([E] PIANO  
RHYTHMS) button.  
In addition to built-in presets, you can create your own original  
music presets (user presets). You can record chord  
progressions up to 999 measures long, which provides plenty  
of versatility for long songs.  
Music presets are divided among six groups, each of which  
corresponds to one of the RHYTHM buttons from [A] through  
[F]. Groups [A] through [E] are built-in preset groups, while  
Group [F] is the user preset group.  
• This displays the music preset screen like the one  
shown below.  
Flashing  
• The D indicator will be flashing on the display.  
This indicates that play with a preset chord progression  
is enabled.  
• Depending on the music preset you selected, the  
F, A, or other indicators may also be flashing  
or displayed.  
E-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Music Presets  
3. Use the buttons from L-4 ([A] POPS/ROCK/  
DANCE) to L-9 ([F] USER RHYTHMS) to select a  
music preset group.  
7. To stop playing, press the L-16 (SYNCHRO/  
ENDING) button or the L-17 (START/STOP)  
button.  
• The D indicator continues to flash on the display  
even after you stop playing. Pressing the L-17 (START/  
STOP) button at this time will restart Auto  
Accompaniment play.  
8. Press the R-15 (EXIT) button to exit the music  
preset screen.  
• You also can press the R-15 (EXIT) button while Auto  
Accompaniment play is in progress. In this case, play  
will stop and the music preset screen will be exited as  
soon as you press the R-15 (EXIT) button.  
• The L-9 ([F] USER RHYTHMS) button is for the user  
preset group. For details, see “Creating a User Preset”  
(page E-53).  
4. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to scroll  
through the music preset numbers until the one  
you want is displayed.  
• Instead of using the preset chord progression, you also can  
use the chord keyboard (page E-28) to play Auto  
Accompaniment chords, and you also can play with the  
rhythm only. For details, see “To change music preset Auto  
Accompaniment settings” (page E-52).  
• Tone, rhythm, and other settings will be configured in  
accordance with the music preset you selected. For  
details about the settings that are configured by a  
music preset, see “Music Preset Settings” (page E-51).  
• During play using a music preset, you can change tone,  
rhythm, tempo, mixer, effect, and other settings.  
5. What you should do to start your performance  
depends on the music preset you selected as  
described below.  
When the F, E, or H indicator is  
flashing on the display:  
3The flashing indicator means that the Digital Keyboard  
is in synchro standby. Press a key in the chord  
keyboard to the left of the split point (page E-17). This  
will start Auto Accompaniment play along with the  
chord progression.  
When the F, E, or H indicator is not  
flashing on the display:  
3Press the L-17 (START/STOP) button. This will start  
Auto Accompaniment play along with the chord  
progression.  
6. Play the melody along with the Auto  
Accompaniment.  
• The preset chord progression repeats the same  
pattern. The number of measures in the progression  
depends on the music preset that is selected. Shorter  
progressions are made up of two to four measures,  
while longer are 30 to 40 measures long. For some  
chord progressions, a fill-in pattern will be inserted  
automatically at the end of a progression pattern.  
• You can change to a different music preset while Auto  
Accompaniment play is in progress, or after stopping  
your performance in step 7, below. Perform steps 3 and  
4 of this procedure to change to another music preset.  
If you change to a different music preset while playing,  
the change will be executed after playback reaches the  
end of the measure you are in when you make the  
change.  
E-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Music Presets  
Music Preset Settings  
The settings listed in the table below are recalled when a music preset is selected.  
• Except for the chord progression, all of the settings can be modified after a music preset is selected. Refer to the information  
noted in the “Go here for more information” column of the table for details about modifying a particular setting.  
• Selecting a different music preset or exiting the music preset screen clears any modifications you make in the currently selected  
preset. If you want to retain modified settings for later use, you can save them as a user preset. For details, see “Creating a User  
Preset” (page E-53).  
Setting  
Tones for the UPPER 1, UPPER 2, and LOWER parts  
Layer on/off, split on/off  
Go here for more information  
Layering and Splitting Tones (page E-15)  
Octave shift for the UPPER 1, UPPER 2, and LOWER parts  
Reverb on/off and type  
Using Octave Shift (page E-18)  
To add reverb to sounds (page E-33)  
Auto harmonize tones  
Using the Mixer (page E-38), Part Parameters (page E-43)  
Volume of the UPPER 1, UPPER 2, LOWER, and auto  
harmonize parts  
Part on/off  
Auto harmonize or arpeggiator on/off and type  
Using Auto Harmonize (page E-30), Playing Arpeggio Phrases  
Automatically (Arpeggiator) (page E-21)  
Arpeggiator hold, arpeggiator speed, arpeggiator part  
Function Menu Settings (page E-126)  
To change the rhythm while using a music preset (page E-52)  
Playing an Auto Accompaniment (page E-26)  
To change the tempo setting (page E-19)  
Rhythm  
Synchro start type (normal, intro, variation)  
Tempo  
Chord progression  
• If you change to a different music preset while a music preset is playing, changes in rhythm and tempo will be executed after the  
measure you are in when you make the change is complete.  
• Though you cannot modify the chord progression of a music preset, you can modify the preset chord progression and save it as  
a user preset. For details, see “Creating a User Preset” (page E-53).  
E-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Music Presets  
To change music preset Auto  
Accompaniment settings  
To change the rhythm while using a music  
preset  
While the music preset screen is displayed, you can use the  
L-18 (ACCOMP ON/OFF) button to change Auto  
Accompaniment settings.  
While the music preset screen is displayed, buttons L-4 ([A]  
POPS/ROCK/DANCE) to L-9 ([F] USER RHYTHMS) function  
as music preset group select buttons. Because of this, you  
need to perform the procedure below to change the rhythm.  
1. Press the R-17 (y) button twice.  
• This displays a rhythm selection screen like the one  
shown below.  
• Each press of the L-18 (ACCOMP ON/OFF) button cycles  
through settings as shown below.  
Setting  
D indicator  
2. Use the buttons from L-4 ([A] POPS/ROCK/  
DANCE) to L-9 ([F] USER RHYTHMS) to select a  
rhythm group.  
Preset chord progression  
Flashing  
Normal Auto Accompaniment  
(Accompaniment Off)  
3. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to scroll  
through the rhythm numbers until the one you  
want is displayed.  
Not displayed  
Displayed  
Normal Auto Accompaniment  
(Accompaniment On)  
4. After selecting the rhythm you want, press the  
R-15 (EXIT) button or press the R-17 (t) button  
twice.  
• This exits the rhythm selection screen.  
• When a preset chord progression or accompaniment off is  
selected, the keyboard can be used for melody play. When  
accompaniment on is selected, the left side range of the  
keyboard is the chord keyboard, and the right side range is  
the melody keyboard.  
• Pressing a button from R-1 ([A] PIANO) through R-12 ([L]  
USER TONES) while a music preset is in use will display  
the tone selection screen. While the tone selection screen  
is displayed, pressing the R-17 (y) button once will  
change to the rhythm selection screen shown in the  
procedure above.  
E-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Music Presets  
5. You can change each of the parameters on the  
Creating a User Preset  
parameter menu as required.  
(1) Use the R-17 (t, y, u, i) buttons to move the 0  
to the parameter you want to change.  
(2) Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting value.  
User Preset Numbers  
Preset areas numbered F:001 through F:050 are for storage  
of user presets. You can have up to 50 user presets stored in  
memory at one time. You can recall a stored user preset after  
pressing the L-9 ([F] USER RHYTHMS) button. See “To  
perform using a music preset” (page E-49) for more  
information.  
• Pressing the R-14 (–, +) buttons at the same time  
returns a parameter to its initial default setting.  
• The following explains the meanings and setting  
ranges of the on-screen items. The settings marked  
with an asterisk (*) in the “Setting Range” column  
are initial defaults.  
To create and save a user preset  
Setting  
Range  
oFF, Normal*,  
Variation,  
Intro  
Item name  
Synchro  
(Synchro type) Accompaniment synchro  
start standby type.  
Description  
1. Perform steps 1 through 4 under “To perform  
using a music preset” (page E-49) and select  
the music preset you want to edit in order to  
create your user music preset.  
Specifies the Auto  
IntroChd  
(Intro chord)  
Specifies the chords of the C* - B,  
Auto Accompaniment intro Cm - Bm  
pattern.  
2. Configure tone and other settings referring to  
“Music Preset Settings” (page E-51).  
EndingChd  
(Ending chord) Auto Accompaniment  
ending pattern.  
Specifies the chords of the C* - B,  
3. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
Cm - Bm  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
• This displays the MP (music preset) editor screen like  
the one shown below.  
AutoFill  
(Auto fill in)  
Specifies whether a fill in  
should be inserted (on) or  
not inserted (oFF) at the  
end of the chord  
on*, oFF  
progression.  
Timing  
Specifies the chord change Normal*, Half,  
(Timing set)  
timing during playback for  
recorded chords. For  
information about  
Double, 3/4,  
3/2  
differences in playback for  
each setting value, see  
“Timing Setting and Chord  
Progression Playback”  
(page E-55).  
• Pressing the R-16 (ENTER) button here will change to  
a screen for editing the chord progression. See “Editing  
a Chord Progression” (page E-57) for more information.  
4. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“Parameter” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
(3) Repeat steps (1) and (2) as required.  
(4) After the settings are the way you want, press the R-15  
(EXIT) button.  
• This displays the parameter menu.  
• This returns to the MP editor screen.  
E-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Music Presets  
6. Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
“Store” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• Pressing the R-15 (EXIT) button in place of step 6 displays  
the confirmation screen shown below. Pressing the R-14  
(YES) button at this time will display the user preset save  
screen in step 6.  
• This displays a screen for specifying the destination  
user preset number and name.  
Save destination user preset number  
To cancel the editor operation without saving the edited  
results, press the R-14 (NO) button.  
User preset name  
To clear user preset data  
7. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select the  
destination user preset number you want.  
1. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button to display  
the MP (music preset) editor screen.  
8. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the  
cursor to the name character position you want  
to change, and then use the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to select the character you want.  
2. Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
“Clear” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• For details about the characters you can input, see  
“Supported Input Characters” (page E-155).  
• To input a space, press both of the R-14 (–, +) buttons  
at the same time.  
• This displays a screen for specifying the number of the  
user preset you want to clear.  
3. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify the  
9. After everything is the way you want, press the  
number of the user preset you want to clear.  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This saves the data.  
4. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• If the user preset number where you are saving the  
data already has data saved to it, a message  
(Replace?) will appear on the display to confirm  
whether you want to replace the existing data with the  
new data. Press the R-14 (YES) button to replace the  
existing data with the new data.  
5. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to clear or  
the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
• The message “Please Wait” will remain on the display  
while a data save operation is in progress. Do not  
perform any other operation while it is displayed.  
Turning off the Digital Keyboard or removing the  
memory card can cause Digital Keyboard data to be  
deleted or become corrupted. It also can cause the  
Digital Keyboard to fail to turn on when the L-1  
(POWER) button is pressed. If this happens, refer to  
“Troubleshooting” (page E-145).  
E-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Music Presets  
Timing Setting and Chord Progression Playback  
This section explains how chord progressions are played in accordance with the “Timing” (Timing set) settings in step 5 under “To  
create and save a user preset” (page E-53). Note that this setting affects playback only. It does not change the chord progression  
data.  
• Normal  
Plays chords at the same timing as the recording.  
• Half  
Plays chords measure-by-measure at a timing that is half that of the recording.  
Example:  
Measure  
1
1
2
1
3
1
C
4
1
Beat  
2
3
4
2
3
4
2
3
4
2
3
4
Chord progression  
Dm  
A7  
Dm  
G7  
EM7  
Am  
C7  
The following shows what happens when the “Half” setting is used to play back a user preset that was created based on a music  
preset whose rhythm is a 4/4 time.  
Half Playback when a 4/4 time rhythm is assigned to the user preset  
Measure  
1
1
2
1
3
1
C
4
1
Beat  
2
3
4
2
3
4
2
3
4
2
3
4
Chord progression  
Dm A7  
Dm G7  
EM7  
Am C7  
Half Playback when a 2/4 time rhythm is assigned to the user preset  
Measure  
1
1
2
1
3
1
C
4
1
Beat  
2
2
2
2
Chord progression  
Dm A7 Dm G7  
EM7 Am C7  
• Double  
Plays chords measure-by-measure at a timing that is double that of the recording.  
Playing back a chord progression like that shown for “Half” above while “Double” is specified results in the progression shown  
below.  
Double Playback when a 4/4 time rhythm is assigned to the user preset  
Measure  
1
1
2
1
3
1
C
4
1
Beat  
2
3
4
2
3
4
2
3
4
4
2
6
3
7
4
8
Chord progression  
Dm  
Dm  
Am  
Double Playback when an 8/4 time rhythm is assigned to the user preset  
Measure  
1
1
2
1
3
1
C
Beat  
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
2
3
5
2
Chord progression  
Dm  
A7  
Dm  
G7  
E-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Music Presets  
• 3/4  
Plays chords measure-by-measure at a timing that is 3/4 times that of the recording. This setting is best for use with a 6/8 time  
rhythm.  
Playing back a chord progression like that shown for “Half” above while “3/4” is specified results in the progression shown below.  
3/4 Playback when a 4/4 time rhythm is assigned to the user preset  
Measure  
1
1
2
1
3
1
C
4
1
Beat  
2
3
4
2
3
4
2
3
4
6
2
2
3
3
4
Chord progression  
Dm  
A7  
Dm  
G7  
EM7  
Am  
C7  
3/4 Playback when a 6/8 time rhythm is assigned to the user preset  
Measure  
1
1
2
1
3
1
C
4
1
Beat  
2
3
4
5
6
2
3
4
5
4
5
6
2
Chord progression  
Dm  
A7  
Dm  
G7  
EM7  
Am  
• 3/2  
Plays chords measure-by-measure at a timing that is 3/2 times that of the recording. This setting is best for use with a 6/4 time  
rhythm.  
Playing back a chord progression like that shown for “Half” above while “3/2” is specified results in the progression shown below.  
3/2 Playback when a 4/4 time rhythm is assigned to the user preset  
Measure  
1
1
2
1
3
1
C
4
1
Beat  
2
3
4
2
3
4
2
3
5
4
2
2
3
3
4
Chord progression  
Dm  
A7 Dm  
G7  
EM7 Am  
C7  
3/2 Playback when a 6/4 time rhythm is assigned to the user preset  
Measure  
1
1
2
1
3
1
4
1
Beat  
2
3
4
5
6
2
3
4
6
4
5
6
2
Chord progression  
Dm  
A7  
Dm  
G7  
C
EM7  
Am  
• When “Double” or “3/2” is selected, chord timing is shifted to a later timing. Any chords that do not fit within a measure are not  
played.  
E-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Music Presets  
5. Perform the following chord progression  
Editing a Chord Progression  
editing operations.  
You can modify the preset chord progression and save it as a  
user preset, or you can create a new chord progression from  
scratch and save it.  
• Change an existing chord (“To modify recorded chord  
data”, page E-58)  
• Delete an existing chord (“To delete recorded chord  
data”, page E-58)  
• Insert a new chord (“To insert a new chord”, page E-58)  
• Delete all existing chords (“Initialize”, under “To perform  
menu operations”, page E-60)  
• Input a series of chords (“To perform step input of  
chords”, page E-59)  
• Key shift all existing chords (“Key Shift”, under “To  
perform menu operations”, page E-60)  
• Insert another music preset chord progression following  
the chord progression data of the preset being edited  
(“Append Chord”, under “To perform menu operations”,  
page E-60)  
Chord Progression Editing Flow  
1. Perform steps 1 through 4 under “To perform  
using a music preset” (page E-49) and select  
the music preset you want to edit in order to  
create your user music preset.  
2. Configure tone and other settings referring to  
“Music Preset Settings” (page E-51).  
• Delete existing chords in a specific measure (“Delete  
Measure”, under “To perform menu operations”, page  
E-60)  
• Insert blank measures at a specific location (“Insert  
Measure”, under “To perform menu operations”, page  
E-60)  
3. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
• This displays the MP (music preset) editor screen like  
the one shown below with the 0 next to “Chord Edit”.  
6. After editing is complete, press the R-15 (EXIT)  
button.  
• This returns to the MP editor screen.  
7. Perform steps 4 through 9 under “To create and  
save a user preset” on page E-53.  
• Steps 4 and 5 can be skipped if they are not necessary.  
4. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This displays the chord editor screen shown below. You  
can use this screen to directly edit the individual chord  
data items of a chord progression.  
Data type name at  
cursor position  
Data being edited  
Cursor  
Data before and after data being edited  
E-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Music Presets  
To modify recorded chord data  
To delete recorded chord data  
1. Perform steps 1 through 4 of the procedure  
under “Chord Progression Editing Flow” on  
page E-57.  
1. Perform steps 1 through 4 of the procedure  
under “Chord Progression Editing Flow” on  
page E-57.  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the  
cursor to the chord you want to edit.  
cursor to the chord you want to delete.  
• You can use the L-15 (dFF) and L-14 (sREW)  
buttons to move the cursor by measure-by-measure.  
3. Press the C-10 (DELETE) button.  
• The chord at the current cursor position will be deleted  
3. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the  
cursor, and then use the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to change the value at the cursor  
position.  
as soon as you press the C-10 (DELETE) button.  
• You cannot delete the first chord of the user preset  
data.  
• The cursor flashes during a value change operation.  
Chord root  
To insert a new chord  
Measure:Beat:Tick  
Chord type  
1. Perform steps 1 through 4 of the procedure  
under “Chord Progression Editing Flow” on  
page E-57.  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the  
cursor to the chord that comes immediately  
before the position where you want to insert a  
chord.  
Cursor  
3. Press the C-11 (INSERT) button.  
• This displays a screen like the one shown below.  
• A “tick” is a time unit that is shorter than one beat. With  
music preset data, 12 ticks equal one beat. This means  
that you can specify a tick value in the range of 00 to  
11. A tick value of 12 advances to the next beat. In the  
case of 4/4 time, a quarter note (2) is 12 ticks and an  
eighth note (6) is 6 ticks.  
Chord progression  
Measure 1  
Measure 2  
Beat 1 Beat 2 Beat 3 Beat 4 Beat 1 Beat 2  
Tick 00 01 02  
09 10 11  
001:1:00  
002:1:00  
For the sample display above, the chord  
change from C to Bm occurs here.  
4. To apply the changed value, press the R-16  
(ENTER) button.  
• This causes the cursor to stop flashing.  
• You cannot change the timing (Measure:Beat:Tick) of  
the first chord of the user preset data.  
E-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Music Presets  
To perform step input of chords  
4. Specify the location of the new chord insert as a  
number of beats after the current cursor  
position.  
1. Perform steps 1 through 4 of the procedure  
under “Chord Progression Editing Flow” on  
page E-57.  
To specify this number of beats  
Press this button:  
after the current cursor position:  
4 beats  
2 beats  
1 beat  
R-1 (5)  
R-2 (1)  
R-3 (2)  
R-7 (6)  
R-8 (7)  
2. Press the C-14 (STEP) button.  
• This will display a step screen like the one shown  
below.  
1/2 beat  
1/4 beat  
• Except for the R-8 (7) button, pressing the R-4 ( )  
button after you press any one of the above buttons will  
increase number of beats by 1.5.  
• Pressing the R-10 (,) button after you press any one  
of the above buttons will change the number of beats  
by 2/3.  
• The R-9 (8) and R-11 (.) buttons are disabled  
during this step.  
3. Use the L-15 (dFF) and L-14 (sREW)  
buttons to move the cursor to the location from  
which you want to perform step input.  
• The cursor will move in one-measure steps.  
5. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This inserts the chord and causes the cursor to appear  
at the “ROOT” position of the inserted chord data. The  
initial default root setting is C.  
4. Specify the length of the chord you want to  
input.  
• For information about how to do this, see the table in  
step 4 under “To insert an event” (page E-89).  
• The R-9 (8) button is disabled during this step. Also  
note that you cannot specify a dotted 16th note.  
5. Press the keyboard keys that correspond to the  
chord you want to input.  
• Press keyboard keys in accordance with the current  
chord fingering mode. For details, see “Selecting a  
Chord Fingering Mode” (page E-28).  
• The chord is input as soon as you press the keyboard  
key, and the cursor will move by the length you  
specified in step 4 to the next measure:beat:tick. From  
there you can input the next chord, if you want.  
6. Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify  
the root.  
7. Use the R-17 (i) button to move the cursor to  
“TYPE” position, and then use the dial or R-14  
(–, +) buttons to configure the type setting.  
• When the cursor is located at “ROOT” or “TYPE”, you  
can use the chord keyboard to specify the chord root or  
type.  
• You cannot input more than 999 measures here.  
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 to input the chords you  
want.  
8. To apply the chord data, press the R-16  
(ENTER) button.  
• If you want to input a series of chords of the same  
length, skip step 4 and perform step 5 only.  
• This causes the cursor to stop flashing.  
7. When you are finished with step input, press  
the R-15 (EXIT) button twice.  
E-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Music Presets  
*1 Deletes all existing chords, and replaces it with four  
measures of data with a C-chord at the first beat of the first  
measure (user preset initial data).  
*2 You will not be able to execute this operation if the number  
of measures specified exceeds 999.  
*3 You cannot delete all measures. If you specify range that  
includes all of the measures, the first measure will remain  
without being deleted.  
To perform menu operations  
1. Perform steps 1 through 4 of the procedure  
under “Chord Progression Editing Flow” on  
page E-57.  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
5. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to execute  
the operation you performed in step 4 or the  
R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
3. This displays a screen like the one shown  
below.  
• Pressing the R-14 (YES) button starts the process. The  
message “Please Wait” will remain on the display if the  
process takes time to perform. Do not perform any  
operation while this message is on the display.  
4. Execute the desired menu operation.  
To do this:  
Do this:  
Delete all existing  
chords  
Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0  
to “Initialize” and then press the R-16  
(ENTER) button.  
(Initialize)*1  
Key shift all existing 1. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the  
chords  
(Key Shift)  
0 to “Key Shift” and then press the R-16  
(ENTER) button.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
specify how much you want to shift the key.  
• You can specify a value from –5 to +6.  
3. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
Insert another music 1. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the  
preset chord  
progression  
0 to “Append Chord” and then press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
following the chord  
progression data of  
the preset being  
edited  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to scroll  
through the music preset numbers until the  
one you want is displayed, and then press  
the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
(Append Chord)*2  
Delete existing  
chords in a specific  
measure  
1. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the  
0 to “DeleteMeas.” and then press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
specify the start measure of the delete  
operation.  
(Delete Measure)*3  
3. Press the R-17 (y) button to move the  
thick brackets (%) to “Size”.  
4. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
specify the number of measures you want  
to delete.  
5. After everything is the way you want, press  
the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
Insert blank  
1. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the  
0 to “InsertMeas.” and then press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
specify the start measure of the insert  
operation.  
measures at a  
specific location  
(Insert Measure)*2  
3. Press the R-17 (y) button to move the  
thick brackets (%) to “Size”.  
4. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
specify the number of measures you want  
to insert.  
5. After everything is the way you want, press  
the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
E-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Saving Keyboard Setups to Registration Memory  
L-1  
R-14  
C-17  
C-10 C-12 C-14 C-16  
C-11 C-13 C-15  
Registration memory lets you store Digital Keyboard setups  
(tone, rhythm, etc.) for instant recall whenever you need them.  
• For information about items that can be part of a  
registration setup, see “Parameter List” (page E-158).  
• When recalling a registration setup, you can recall only the  
setting items related to accompaniments, or only the setting  
items related to scales. For more information, see  
“RegFltAcmp (Registration Filter: Accompaniment)” (page  
E-127) and “RegFltScal (Registration Filter: Scale)” (page  
E-127).  
C-10 C-11 C-12 C-13 C-14 C-15 C-16  
You can have up to 96 setups in registration memory at one  
time. The C-10 (BANK) and C-11 (1) to C-16 (6) buttons are  
used for selecting bank and area.  
Area 1 Area 2 Area 3 Area 4 Area 5 Area 6  
Bank 1  
Bank 2  
Setup  
1-1  
Setup  
1-2  
Setup  
1-3  
Setup  
1-4  
Setup  
1-5  
Setup  
1-6  
Setup  
2-1  
Setup  
2-2  
Setup  
2-3  
Setup  
2-4  
Setup  
2-5  
Setup  
2-6  
Bank 16 Setup  
16-1  
Setup  
16-2  
Setup  
16-3  
Setup  
16-4  
Setup  
16-5  
Setup  
16-6  
• Each press of the C-10 (BANK) button cycles through the  
bank numbers, from 1 to 16.  
• Pressing a button from C-11 (1) to C-16 (6) selects the  
corresponding area in the currently selected bank.  
Registration Save Example  
This example saves the data shown in the table below to the  
following setups in Bank 1.  
• Initial melody setup saved to Setup 1-1.  
• Second melody setup saved to Setup 1-2.  
• Third melody setup saved to Setup 1-3.  
Setup 1-1  
E:016  
A:015  
080  
Setup 1-2  
H:001  
E:013  
140  
Setup 1-3  
A:001  
A:044  
089  
Tone Number  
Rhythm Number  
Tempo  
B
E-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Saving Keyboard Setups to Registration Memory  
To save a setup to registration  
memory  
To recall a setup from registration  
memory  
1. Configure the tone, rhythm, and other settings  
1. Press the C-10 (BANK) button to select the bank  
you want to include in the setup.  
that contains the setup you want to recall.  
2. Press the C-10 (BANK) button to select the bank  
2. Use buttons C-11 (1) to C-16 (6) to select the  
you want.  
area that contains the setup you want to recall.  
• Each press of the C-10 (BANK) button cycles through  
the bank numbers.  
• This will recall the registration memory setup and  
automatically configure the Digital Keyboard settings  
accordingly.  
Bank 2 selected  
Setup 6-1 recalled  
• While the “BANK” screen is displayed after pressing the  
C-10 (BANK) button, use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons  
to select the bank you want.  
• If you do not perform any operation for a few seconds,  
the display will return to previous screen automatically.  
• Notes currently being sounded by the keyboard may stop if  
you recall a setup that causes a change in octave shift  
(page E-18). To keep this from happening, either select a  
setup that does not cause a change in the octave shift  
setting, or hold down the pedal (which will cause notes  
currently being played to be sustained).  
3. While holding down the C-17 (STORE) button,  
press a button from C-11 (1) to C-16 (6) to select  
an area.  
• This will save the settings you configured in step 1 into  
the applicable setup.  
• If there is anything already stored in the setup, it will be  
replaced (deleted) with the new setup.  
Registered as Setup 2-1  
• The message “Please Wait” will remain on the display  
while a data save operation is in progress. Do not  
perform any other operation while it is displayed.  
Turning off the Digital Keyboard or removing the  
memory card can cause Digital Keyboard data to be  
deleted or become corrupted. It also can cause the  
Digital Keyboard to fail to turn on when the L-1  
(POWER) button is pressed. If this happens, refer to  
“Troubleshooting” (page E-145).  
E-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
C-5 C-6 C-7  
R-15  
R-1  
-
R-12  
R-16  
R-17  
R-14  
R-13  
L-13 L-15  
L-14  
C-11  
C-10 C-12 C-13  
C-14  
R-19  
R-20  
L-17  
C-17  
You can use the song sequencer to record keyboard play  
(including Auto Accompaniment), or to record individual parts  
(multi-track recording) and combine them into a final song.  
After recording data, you can edit each individual note (event).  
You can have up to five recorded songs (approximately  
30,000 notes total) stored in memory at the same time.  
Starting One-touch Recording  
(EASY REC)  
EASY REC lets you start recording of keyboard play with a  
single button operation.  
• EASY REC is a function of the song sequencer. For details  
on using the song sequencer, see “What you can do with  
the song sequencer” (page E-65).  
• EASY REC can be used to record keyboard play that uses  
a music preset (page E-49). For details, see “To use EASY  
REC to record a performance using a music preset” (page  
E-65).  
• The message “Please Wait” will remain on the display  
while a data save operation is in progress. Do not  
perform any other operation while it is displayed.  
Turning off the Digital Keyboard or removing the  
memory card can cause Digital Keyboard data to be  
deleted or become corrupted. It also can cause the  
Digital Keyboard to fail to turn on when the L-1  
(POWER) button is pressed. If this happens, refer to  
“Troubleshooting” (page E-145).  
To use EASY REC to record  
1. Configure Digital Keyboard settings for your  
performance.  
• Configure the following settings: tone and rhythm  
selection, tempo, layer and split, synchro standby  
(when using Auto Accompaniment), mixer, etc. For  
details about settings that can be configured, see  
“Recording Start” under “System Track and Track 01  
through 16 Common Recording Content” (page E-66)  
and “System Track Recording Content” (page E-66).  
• Performing step 2 below enters record standby. After  
that, recording will start whenever you play something  
on the keyboard. After step 2, take care that you do not  
accidentally press a keyboard key and unintentionally  
start recording.  
E-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
2. Press the C-6 (RECORD) button.  
(4) Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to “Precount”  
and then use the R-14 (–, +) buttons to turn the  
precount on or off.  
Turing on the precount inserts a one-measure count  
before the start of recording when you press the L-17  
(START/STOP) button in step 4.  
(5) Press the R-15 (EXIT) button to exit the menu.  
• The button will start flashing and the EASY REC screen  
shown below will appear on the display.  
4. Start playing something on the keyboard.  
• Recording starts automatically when you perform any  
one of the following operations.  
Song area number  
– Playing on the keyboard  
– Pressing the L-13 (INTRO), L-14 (NORMAL/  
FILL-IN), or L-15 (VARIATION/FILL-IN) button  
– Pressing the L-17 (START/STOP) button. To input  
one or more rests before starting recording, press the  
L-17 (START/STOP) button to start recording, and  
then start keyboard play at the point you want.  
• Starting recording will cause the C-6 (RECORD) button  
to change from flashing to lit. During recording, the  
display will show the current measure (MEASURE) and  
beat (BEAT).  
Arrows (e) will indicate all the parts in Group A. This indicates the  
Digital Keyboard is currently in system track (page E-65) record  
standby.  
PITCH BEND wheel (S-1) and pedal operations are  
also recorded.  
• When recording reaches a point where there is less  
than 100 notes of remaining memory capacity, the  
current measure (MEASURE) and beat (BEAT) values  
will start flashing.  
• An asterisk (*) next to a song area number indicates  
that there is already data recorded in that area.  
Selecting a song area that already contains recorded  
data and starting a new recording will cause the  
existing system track data to be deleted.  
3. Perform the following steps to configure beat  
5. To stop recording, press the L-17 (START/  
and other settings.  
STOP) button.  
(1) While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION) button,  
press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
• After recording stops, the initial song sequencer mode  
screen appears on the display.  
This will display a menu like the one shown below,  
with the 0 next to “Beat” (beat).  
• At this time you can press the L-17 (START/STOP)  
button to replay what you have just recorded. For  
details about playing back recorded content, see  
“Playing a Recorded Song” (page E-74).  
(2) Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to configure the  
beat setting.  
6. To exit the song sequencer, press the C-5  
(SONG SEQUENCER) button or the R-15 (EXIT)  
button.  
You can specify a beat setting of 2/4 to 8/4, 2/8 to  
16/8.  
(3) Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
“Metronome” and then use the R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
turn the metronome on or off.  
Turning on the metronome causes it to sound a count  
during recording, but not during playback.  
E-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
To use EASY REC to record a performance  
using a music preset  
What you can do with the song  
sequencer  
1. Perform steps 1 through 4 under “To perform  
The simplest use of the song sequencer is to record a  
performance as you play it. For details, see “To use EASY  
REC to record” (page E-63). Virtually everything you play on  
the keyboard can be recorded by the song sequencer.  
You also can use the song sequencer to perform multi-track  
recording of 17 different tracks and assemble them into a final  
song. For example, you can first record a piano track, followed  
by a bass track, then a guitar track or tracks that feature other  
musical instruments.  
using a music preset” (page E-49).  
2. Press the C-6 (RECORD) button.  
• The button will start flashing and the EASY REC screen  
will appear on the display.  
Songs, tracks, and parts  
A single song can be made up of up to 17 tracks. The 17  
tracks are broken down as shown in the table below.  
3. Start to play something using a music preset.  
For details, see “To perform using a music  
preset” (page E-49).  
Part  
Track  
Part Contents  
Number  
• This will start recording, along with Auto  
Accompaniment in accordance with the preset chord  
progression.  
• Starting recording will cause the C-6 (RECORD) button  
to change from flashing to lit. During recording, the  
display will show the current measure (MEASURE) and  
beat (BEAT).  
Auto Accompaniment (Auto  
harmonize tone)  
A04  
A05  
A06  
A07  
Keyboard (UPPER 1 part)  
Keyboard (UPPER 2 part)  
Keyboard (LOWER part)  
Auto Accompaniment  
(Percussion part)  
A09  
A10  
A11  
A12  
A13  
A14  
A15  
4. To stop recording, press the L-17 (START/  
Auto Accompaniment  
(Drums part)  
STOP) button.  
Auto Accompaniment  
(Bass part)  
• After recording stops, the initial song sequencer mode  
screen appears on the display.  
• At this time you can press the L-17 (START/STOP)  
button to replay what you have just recorded. For  
details about playing back recorded content, see  
“Playing a Recorded Song” (page E-74).  
System  
Track  
Song  
Auto Accompaniment  
(Chord 1 part)  
Auto Accompaniment  
(Chord 2 part)  
Auto Accompaniment  
(Chord 3 part)  
5. To exit the song sequencer, press the C-5  
(SONG SEQUENCER) button or the R-15 (EXIT)  
button.  
Auto Accompaniment  
(Chord 4 part)  
Auto Accompaniment  
(Chord 5 part)  
A16  
B01  
B16  
Track 01  
Track 16  
Keyboard (B01 part)  
Keyboard (B16 part)  
• The Digital Keyboard uses multiple parts simultaneously to  
sound Auto Accompaniment, a keyboard layer tone, and  
keyboard split tone at the same time. The system track is  
used to record the notes of these parts in a single location.  
• Tracks 01 through 16 each correspond to a single musical  
instrument part. Each track is used to record the notes of  
each individual part.  
• The parts shown in the table above correspond to mixer  
parts. For details, see “Using the Mixer” (page E-38).  
• Part B10 is a drum sound only part.  
B
E-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
System Track and Track 01 through 16  
Common Recording Content  
• Due to the way song parts are configured, settings  
configured by a recalled registration are applied to different  
numbered parts than they were assigned to when the setup  
was saved, as shown below.  
Recording Start  
• Beat setting  
• Rhythm selection  
• Tempo setting  
Parts when registration  
setup is saved  
Parts when registration is  
recalled for song recording  
• Scale setting  
• The mixer settings below  
UPPER 1 part (A01)  
UPPER 2 part (A02)  
LOWER part (A03)  
UPPER 1 part (A05)  
UPPER 2 part (A06)  
LOWER part (A07)  
– All part parameters from A04 through A07 and B01  
through B16 (Excluding part on/off)  
– Part parameters from A09 through A16: part on/off,  
coarse tune, fine tune, scale enable, DSP line  
– DSP parameters: volume, pan, reverb send  
• Effect settings  
Auto Harmonize tone part  
(A04)  
Auto Harmonize tone part  
(A04)  
• Accomp volume  
For details about the configuration of song parts, see  
“Songs, tracks, and parts” (page E-65).  
During Recording  
• Keyboard play  
• Pitch bender operations  
• Pedal operations  
S-2 (MODULATION) button operations  
• The moment you call up a registration setup or One Touch  
Preset while recording, the setting information registered  
with the registration setup or One Touch Preset is recorded  
to the system track. The registration setup or One Touch  
Preset itself is not recorded.  
System Track Recording Content  
Track 01 through 16 Recording Content  
Recording Start  
• Tones for the UPPER 1, UPPER 2, and LOWER parts  
• Layer and split on/off  
Recording Start  
• Part tone selection for the track  
• Split point setting  
During Recording  
• Octave shift for the UPPER 1, UPPER 2, and LOWER parts  
• The function menu item settings below (page E-126)  
– Arpeggiator hold, arpeggiator speed, arpeggiator part  
• Auto harmonize or arpeggiator on/off and type  
• Synchro standby (Normal, Variation, Intro)  
• Music preset (Only when using EASY REC.)  
• Part tone selection for the track  
• The mixer settings below  
– All part parameters from B01 through B16  
(except part on/off)  
Panel Settings and Header Settings  
During Recording  
• Rhythm selection  
• Tempo setting  
Before starting recording with the song sequencer, you need  
to select the tone and rhythm, and also configure other  
settings such as tempo, mixer settings, etc. These are called  
“panel settings” because they are configured using the Digital  
Keyboard’s control panel. When you start recording, panel  
settings are stored in the header of the song. Settings in the  
header of a song are called “header settings”.  
• The “Recording Start” settings under “System Track and  
Track 01 through 16 Common Recording Content” (page  
E-66), “System Track Recording Content” (page E-66) and  
“Track 01 through 16 Recording Content (page E-66) are  
stored as header settings.  
• All of the items under “Recording Start” above, except for  
the function menu item settings and split point setting  
• Chord play using the chord keyboard  
• The rhythm controller operations below  
L-13 (INTRO), L-14 (NORMAL/FILL-IN), L-15  
(VARIATION/FILL-IN), and L-16 (SYNCHRO/ENDING)  
button operations  
• Settings recalled from registration memory  
• Settings recalled using One Touch Preset  
• Settings recalled from scale memory  
• The button operations below  
• Only header settings can be changed after song recording  
is complete. For details, see “Using Panel Record to  
Rewrite Song Header Settings” (page E-73).  
D-6 (KEY C) through D-17 (KEY B)  
E-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
4. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to select the  
Recording Individual Tracks  
system track.  
This section explains how to record to the system track and  
how to record to Tracks 01 through 16. For details about track  
configuration and what is recorded to each track, see “What  
you can do with the song sequencer” (page E-65).  
• If the system track already contains recorded data,  
starting recording in step 7 below will cause the current  
system track data to be deleted.  
To record a performance to the system track  
1. Press the C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER) button to  
enter the song sequencer mode.  
5. Configure panel settings as required for your  
performance.  
• Configure the following settings: tone and rhythm  
selection, tempo, layer and split, synchro standby  
(when using Auto Accompaniment), mixer, etc. For  
details about settings that can be configured, see  
“Recording Start” under “System Track and Track 01  
through 16 Common Recording Content” (page E-66)  
and “System Track Recording Content” (page E-66).  
For information about mixer settings, see “Mixer  
Settings in the Song Sequencer Mode” (page E-71).  
Song area number  
6. Perform the following steps to configure beat  
• An asterisk (*) next to a song area number indicates  
that there is already data recorded in that area.  
L in the level meter indicates that the system track is  
currently selected, while M indicates that another track  
(01 through 16) is selected. In the case of M, a pointer  
(e) indicates which track is selected.  
and other settings.  
(1) While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION) button,  
press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
This will display a menu like the one shown below, with  
the 0 next to “Beat” (beat).  
• A black box ( ) in the level meter above a track  
number indicates that there is already data recorded in  
that track.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select a  
song area number.  
• Selecting a song area that already contains recorded  
data will immediately recall the header settings of the  
song (page E-66).  
(2)Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to configure the  
beat setting.  
3. Press the C-6 (RECORD) button.  
You can specify a beat setting of 2/4 to 8/4, 2/8 to 16/8.  
(3)Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
“Metronome” and then use the R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
turn the metronome on or off.  
Turning on the metronome causes it to sound a count  
during recording, but not during playback.  
(4)Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to “Precount”  
and then use the R-14 (–, +) buttons to turn the  
precount on or off.  
• The button will start to flash and the Digital Keyboard  
will enter record standby, which means recording will  
start whenever you play something on the keyboard.  
Up to step 7, take care that you do not accidentally  
press a keyboard key and unintentionally start  
recording.  
Turing on the precount inserts a one-measure count  
before the start of recording when you press the L-17  
(START/STOP) button in step 7.  
(5)Press the R-15 (EXIT) button to exit the menu.  
E-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
To record to Tracks 01 through 16  
• Page 2 of the menu screen has a “RecType” setting, but  
this setting cannot be used when recording a performance  
to the system track.  
1. Press the C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER) button to  
enter the song sequencer mode.  
7. Start playing something on the keyboard.  
• Recording starts automatically when you perform any  
one of the following operations.  
– Playing on the keyboard  
– Pressing the L-13 (INTRO), L-14 (NORMAL/  
FILL-IN), or L-15 (VARIATION/FILL-IN) button  
– Pressing the L-17 (START/STOP) button. To input  
one or more rests before starting recording, press the  
L-17 (START/STOP) button to start recording, and  
then start keyboard play at the point you want.  
• Starting recording will cause the C-6 (RECORD) button  
to change from flashing to lit. During recording, the  
display will show the current measure (MEASURE) and  
beat (BEAT).  
Song area number  
PITCH BEND wheel (S-1) and pedal operations are  
also recorded.  
• When recording reaches a point where there is less  
than 100 notes of remaining memory capacity, the  
current measure (MEASURE) and beat (BEAT) values  
will start flashing.  
• An asterisk (*) next to a song area number indicates  
that there is already data recorded in that area.  
L in the level meter indicates that the system track is  
currently selected, while M indicates that another track  
(01 through 16) is selected. In the case of M, which  
track is selected is indicated by the position of a pointer  
(e).  
• A black box ( ) in the level meter above a track  
number indicates that there is already data recorded in  
that track.  
8. To stop recording, press the L-17 (START/  
STOP) button.  
• At this time you can press the L-17 (START/STOP)  
button to replay what you have just recorded. For  
details about playing back recorded content, see  
“Playing a Recorded Song” (page E-74).  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select a  
song area number.  
• Selecting a song area that already contains recorded  
data will immediately recall the header settings of the  
song (page E-66).  
9. To exit the song sequencer, press the C-5  
(SONG SEQUENCER) button or the R-15 (EXIT)  
button.  
3. Press the C-6 (RECORD) button.  
• The button will start to flash and the Digital Keyboard  
will enter record standby, which means recording will  
start whenever you play something on the keyboard.  
Up to step 7, take care that you do not accidentally  
press a keyboard key and unintentionally start  
recording.  
E-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
4. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to select a track  
(5) Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to “RecType”,  
and then use the R-14 (–, +) buttons to select “REPL”  
or “OVDB”.  
(Track 01 through Track 16).  
When you want to perform this type  
of recording:  
Select this  
RecType option:  
Delete any data currently existing in  
the track being recorded to and start a  
new recording.  
REPL (Replace)  
Overdub any data currently existing in OVDB (Overdub)  
the track being recorded to with the  
new recording.  
5. Configure panel settings as required for your  
performance.  
(6) Press the R-15 (EXIT) button to exit the menu.  
• Configure the following settings: tone selection, tempo,  
mixer settings, etc. For details about settings that can  
be configured, see “Recording Start” under “System  
Track and Track 01 through 16 Common Recording  
Content”* (page E-66) and “Track 01 through 16  
Recording Content” (page E-66). For information about  
mixer settings, see “Mixer Settings in the Song  
Sequencer Mode” (page E-71).  
7. Start playing something on the keyboard.  
• This will start recording and cause the C-6 (RECORD)  
button to change from flashing to lit. During recording,  
the display will show the current measure (MEASURE)  
and beat (BEAT).  
• To input one or more rests before starting recording,  
press the L-17 (START/STOP) button to start  
recording, and then start keyboard play at the point you  
want.  
PITCH BEND wheel (S-1) and pedal operations are  
also recorded.  
• When recording reaches a point where there is less  
than 100 notes of remaining memory capacity, the  
current measure (MEASURE) and beat (BEAT) values  
will start flashing.  
* Excluding rhythm selection and accomp volume.  
6. Perform the following steps to configure beat  
and other settings.  
(1) While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION) button,  
press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
This will display a menu like the one shown below, with  
the 0 next to “Beat” (beat).  
8. To stop recording, press the L-17 (START/  
STOP) button.  
• At this time you can press the L-17 (START/STOP)  
button to replay what you have just recorded. For  
details about playing back recorded content, see  
“Playing a Recorded Song” (page E-74).  
9. To exit the song sequencer, press the C-5  
(SONG SEQUENCER) button or the R-15 (EXIT)  
button.  
(2) Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to configure the beat  
setting.  
You can specify a beat setting of 2/4 to 8/4, 2/8 to 16/8.  
(3) Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
“Metronome” and then use the R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
turn the metronome on or off.  
Turning on the metronome causes it to count a count  
during recording, but not during playback.  
(4) Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to “Precount”  
and then use the R-14 (–, +) buttons to turn the  
precount on or off.  
Turing on the precount inserts a one-measure count  
before the start of recording when you press the L-17  
(START/STOP) button in step 7.  
E-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
To clear the content of a single track  
immediately after recording it  
To clear a single song immediately after  
recording it  
1. While the song sequencer mode initial screen is  
on the display after track recording is complete,  
hold down the R-13 (FUNCTION) button as you  
press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
1. While the song sequencer mode initial screen is  
on the display after track recording is complete,  
hold down the R-13 (FUNCTION) button as you  
press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
• This displays the song sequencer menu with the 0  
• This displays the song sequencer menu.  
located at “ClearTrack”.  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“ClearSong” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This causes the “Clear Song” screen to appear. At this  
time the target song for the clear operation is the one  
you just recorded.  
3. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This will cause the confirmation message “Sure?” to  
appear.  
2. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This causes the “Clear Track” screen to appear. At this  
time the target track for the clear operation is the one  
you just recorded.  
4. Press the R-14 (YES) button to clear the song  
data or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
3. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• For information on how to select a particular song and clear  
its content, see “To clear a song” (page E-77).  
• This will cause the confirmation message “Sure?” to  
appear.  
4. Press the R-14 (YES) button to clear the track  
data or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
• For information on how to select a particular track and clear  
its content, see “To clear a single track” (page E-80).  
E-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
Mixer Settings in the Song Sequencer Mode  
Re-recording Part of a Song  
(Punch-in Recording)  
You can re-record parts of a song you previously recorded in  
order to correct errors, etc. Simply enter the record standby  
mode and play back the previously recorded song (punch-in  
playback) and then play the new notes when playback  
reaches the location of the part you want to change.  
You can access the mixer during playback, playback standby,  
or record standby (C-6 (RECORD) button flashing), or while  
recording is in progress (C-6 (RECORD) button lit). Press the  
C-7 (MIXER) button to display the mixer screen. To return to  
the song sequencer mode screen, press the C-7 (MIXER)  
button again or press the R-15 (EXIT) button.  
The table below shows how mixer parts correspond to song  
sequencer parts.  
Mistake  
Mixer  
Parts A04 to A07, A09 to A16  
Parts B01 to B16  
Song Sequencer  
System Track  
Playback  
Tracks 01 through 16  
Use punch-in recording to  
re-record only this part.  
Supported Mixer Operations during Playback or Playback  
Standby  
All mixer settings can be configured during playback or  
playback standby, subject to the following precautions.  
• If you want to change mixer settings during playback  
standby, change them after selecting the song you want to  
play back. If you change mixer settings and then change  
the song selection, the header settings of the newly  
selected song will be recalled and mixer settings will be  
changed accordingly.  
To start re-recording from a particular  
location during playback (Manual Punch-in)  
1. Press the C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER) button to  
enter the song sequencer mode.  
• The only mixer settings you can change during playback  
standby are those that are included in the song header of  
the currently selected song. If mixer settings were changed  
part way through when recording the song, the later  
recorded mixer settings will supersede any settings you  
make during playback standby.  
2. Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to select a  
song area number.  
3. Press the C-6 (RECORD) button to enter record  
standby.  
• This causes the button to start flashing.  
Supported Mixer Operations during Record Standby  
The mixer settings for the parts shown below (excluding part  
on/off) are supported, depending on the track being recorded  
to. Settings are recorded to the header settings (page E-66),  
the same way settings are stored when recording is started.  
4. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to select the track  
you want to partially re-record.  
5. Hold down the C-6 (RECORD) button until the  
punch-in/punch-out screen shown below  
appears.  
System Track  
Tracks 01 through 16  
A05 (UPPER 1), A06 (UPPER 2), Parts corresponding to  
A07 (LOWER), A04 (Auto  
harmonize) parts  
each track  
(B01 through B16)  
Supported Mixer Operations During Recording  
Mixer settings cannot be configured during recording to the  
system track.  
Configuration of mixer settings (except for part on/off) is  
supported for a part (B01 through B16) that corresponds to a  
track when recording to any track from 01 through 16 shown.  
Any change in a mixer setting on the mixer screen is recorded  
as soon as it is made.  
For details about mixer functions and operations, see “Using  
the Mixer” (page E-38).  
E-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
6. Press the L-17 (START/STOP) button.  
To specify the punch-in recording range  
before starting (Auto Punch-in)  
• This starts punch-in playback.  
• The following operations are supported during punch-in  
playback. They help you move to the re-recording start  
point quickly and easily.  
1. Play the song and determine what part of what  
track you want to re-record.  
To do this:  
Fast Forward  
Do this:  
• For details about play back, see “Playing a Recorded  
Song” (page E-74).  
Hold down the L-15 (dFF) button.  
• You can specify a specific measure, beat, and tick* for  
the start point and the end point of the range to be  
re-recorded. Normally, it is probably best to specify the  
start of a measure or beat as the start point and end  
point. If you want to specify specific ticks, you can  
display the track to be re-recorded on the event editor  
screen and determine the desired location there. For  
details about event editing, see “Editing Events” (page  
E-82).  
Fast Backward  
Hold down the L-14 (sREW)  
button.  
Pause  
Press the L-16 (PAUSE) button.  
Press the L-16 (PAUSE) button.  
Restart paused  
playback.  
7. When playback reaches the point from which  
you want to start re-recording, start playing  
something on the keyboard.  
* For details about ticks, see “Reading Event Data”  
(page E-83).  
• Punch-in recording starts the moment you start to play  
something on the keyboard.  
• Any one of the following also will start punch-in  
recording: a pedal or pitch bender operation; changing  
the tone setting; changing the rhythm, or tempo  
setting*.  
2. Press the C-6 (RECORD) button to enter record  
standby.  
• This causes the button to start flashing.  
3. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to select the track  
* System track only  
you want to partially re-record.  
• To start punch-in recording without making any change  
in the notes played or the settings used, press the C-6  
(RECORD) button.  
• Starting recording will cause the C-6 (RECORD) button  
to light.  
4. Hold down the C-6 (RECORD) button until the  
punch-in/punch-out screen appears. You can  
release the button at that time.  
5. Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to select  
“Auto” for the “Mode” setting.  
• This displays a range specification screen like the one  
shown below.  
• If you want to delete all of the data in the track following the  
section you just re-recorded with punch-in recording, press  
the C-6 (RECORD) button in place of the L-17 (START/  
STOP) button in step 8.  
• If you want to cancel punch-in recording and retain the  
original track data, hold down the C-6 (RECORD) button  
until it becomes unlit.  
8. To stop recording, press the L-17 (START/  
STOP) button.  
• This will end punch-in recording and cause the C-6  
(RECORD) button to become unlit.  
• Any previously recorded data in the track that comes  
after the point you stopped punch-in recording will  
remain in the track.  
E-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
6. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the  
cursor, use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
change the value at the cursor position, and  
then press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
Using Panel Record to Rewrite  
Song Header Settings  
The header of each song contains “header settings”, which  
are settings that were in effect on the Digital Keyboard when  
recording was performed. You can use a “panel record”  
operation to rewrite a song’s header settings with the Digital  
Keyboard’s current setup.  
• If you have already specified a range using the locator  
screen (page E-75), you can copy that range to this  
screen by holding down the L-13 (REPEAT) button.  
The following items are header settings that can be rewritten  
using the panel record operation.  
• Rhythm selection  
• Tempo setting  
• Scale setting  
• The mixer settings below  
– All part parameters from A04 through A07 and B01  
through B16 (Excluding part on/off)  
– Part parameters from A09 through A16: part on/off,  
coarse tune, fine tune, scale enable, DSP line  
– DSP parameters: volume, pan, reverb send  
• Effect settings  
Recording start point  
Recording end point  
7. After specifying the recording start point and  
• Accomp volume  
• UPPER 1 part tone, UPPER 2 part tone, and LOWER part  
tone selections  
end point, press the L-17 (START/STOP) button.  
• This starts punch-in playback. You can perform fast  
forward and fast backward operations during punch-in  
playback using the operations described in step 6  
under “To start re-recording from a particular location  
during playback (Manual Punch-in)” (page E-71).  
• You can start punch-in playback from one measure  
prior to the current recording start point by pressing the  
L-13 (REPEAT) button which causes the ?  
indicator to appear on the display.  
To perform a panel record operation  
1. Press the C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER) button to  
enter the song sequencer mode.  
8. When playback reaches the re-record point you  
specified, start playing something on the  
keyboard.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select a  
• Punch-in recording will start automatically when  
playback reaches the record start point you specified.  
The C-6 (RECORD) button will light when recording  
starts.  
• Recording stops and punch-in recording is exited  
automatically when the record end point you specified  
is reached. At this time the C-6 (RECORD) button will  
become unlit.  
• If you want to stop recording before the record end  
point you specified is reached, press the L-17 (START/  
STOP) button. Any previously recorded data in the  
track that comes after the point you stopped punch-in  
recording will remain in the track.  
song area number.  
3. Configure panel settings so they reflect the  
settings you want to write as the header  
settings.  
• You can configure the following settings: mixer settings,  
tempo, system track rhythm, track tone selection, etc.  
• To change the system track UPPER 1, UPPER 2, and  
LOWER part tones or mixer settings, use the mixer to  
change the settings of parts A05 (UPPER 1), A06  
(UPPER 2), and A07 (LOWER).  
• When “EOT” (End of Track) is selected for the  
recording start point, the start point for punch-in  
recording is the end of the track.  
• When “OFF” is selected for the recording end point,  
punch-in recording will not stop automatically because  
no end point is specified. To stop punch-in recording in  
this case, press the L-17 (START/STOP) button.  
4. After all of the panels settings are the way you  
want, hold the R-13 (FUNCTION) button as you  
press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
• This displays the song sequencer menu.  
E-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
5. Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
4. Press the L-17 (START/STOP) button.  
• This starts playback. The following operations are  
supported during playback.  
“PanelRecord”.  
To do this:  
Fast forward  
Fast backward  
Pause  
Do this:  
Hold down the L-15 (dFF) button.  
Hold down the L-14 (sREW) button.  
Press the L-16 (PAUSE) button.  
Press the L-16 (PAUSE) button.  
Restart paused  
playback  
Perform repeat  
playback  
Perform steps 3 through 5 under “To  
repeat play a specific section of a  
song” (page E-139).  
6. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
7. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to execute  
the panel record operation or the R-14 (NO)  
button to cancel.  
• Even while playback is paused, you can still perform  
fast forward playback by holding down the L-15  
(dFF) button or fast backward playback by holding  
down the L-14 (sREW). Releasing either button goes  
back into pause.  
• While playback is in progress or playback standby, you  
can use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to select the track  
you want. Playing keyboard keys sounds the parts that  
correspond to the currently selected track (A04 to A07  
for the system track).  
• Playback stops automatically when it reaches the end  
of a song. To stop playback part way through, press the  
L-17 (START/STOP) button.  
Playing a Recorded Song  
This section explains how to perform the following operations  
on songs recorded in the song sequencer mode.  
• Play a song.  
• Fast forward, fast backward, pause, unpause.  
• Play a specific part in a song.  
• Repeat play a specific section of a song.  
• Assign a name to a song.  
• Delete a song.  
To play a recorded song  
1. Press the C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER) button to  
enter the song sequencer mode.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select a  
song area number.  
3. Configure mixer settings, tempo, and other  
panel settings you want to use for playback.  
• To change the system track UPPER 1, UPPER 2, and  
LOWER part tones or mixer settings, use the mixer to  
change the settings of parts A05 (UPPER 1), A06  
(UPPER 2), and A07 (LOWER).  
• The above settings are not required if you want to play  
the song as it was recorded.  
E-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
To repeat play a specific phrase  
To play back a particular part alone  
1. Press the C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER) button to  
1. Hold down the L-13 (REPEAT) button until the  
locator screen shown below appears on the  
display.  
enter the song sequencer mode.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select a  
song area number.  
3. Press the C-7 (MIXER) button to display the  
mixer screen.  
4. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to select the part  
you want to play (A04 through A16, B01 through  
B16).  
• For example, to play only the melody that was recorded  
using the UPPER 1 part and recorded into the system  
track, select part A05. For details about the content of  
each part, see “How Parts are Organized” (page E-38).  
Start point input area  
End point input area  
2. Specify a measure as the start point of the  
5. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the thick  
brackets (%) to “Part”.  
phrase to be repeat played.  
(1) Press the R-14 (+) button.  
This will input “001:01:00” into the start point input area  
(A), and cause the cursor to start to flash.  
(2) Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify the start  
measure number.  
3. Specify a measure as the end point of the  
phrase to be repeat played.  
(1) Press the R-17 (i) three times to move the cursor to  
the end point input area.  
Press the R-14 (+) button.  
The end point input area (B) initially shows the  
measure that is one measure after the start point.  
(2) Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify the end  
measure number.  
6. Press the R-14 (–, +) buttons at the same time.  
• This causes the setting to change to “Sol” (Solo).  
7. Press the L-17 (START/STOP) button.  
• This starts playback only of the part you selected in  
step 4.  
4. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This causes the cursor to stop flashing.  
• Playback stops automatically when it reaches the end  
of a song. To stop playback part way through, press the  
L-17 (START/STOP) button.  
5. Press the R-15 (EXIT) button to exit the locator  
screen.  
6. Perform the following steps to start phrase  
repeat play.  
(1) Press the L-13 (REPEAT) button.  
This causes the ? indicator to appear on the  
display.  
(2) Press the L-17 (START/STOP) button.  
The specified phrase plays back in a loop.  
E-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
7. To stop playback, press the L-17 (START/STOP)  
Editing a Song  
button.  
The following operations are supported during song editing.  
• Deleting a specific song or all songs  
• Copying a song from one area to another  
• Deleting specific measures from a song  
• Inserting blank measures into a song  
• Extracting system track recorded content to track 04  
through 07 or 09 through 16  
• Pressing the R-15 (EXIT) button without pressing the R-16  
(ENTER) button in step 4 above will cancel the phrase  
setting operation and close the locator screen.  
• The start point and end point specified on the locator  
screen by the above operation will be displayed as the  
initial default values when you display the screen of editing  
the next event.  
• Renaming songs  
– “To delete all events in a specific range of a track” (page  
E-88)  
To start a song editor operation  
– “To copy the events within a specific range to a desired  
location” (page E-89)  
– “To quantize all note events within specific range of a  
track” (page E-91)  
– “To delete all pitch bender events within a specific range  
of a track” (page E-92)  
This lets you repeat play and check the phrase so you can  
perform the above operation to edit it.  
1. Press the C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER) button to  
enter the song sequencer mode.  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-5 (EDIT) button to display  
the edit menu.  
3. Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
“Song Edit” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays the song editor menu shown below.  
E-76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
4. Press the R-17 (y) button to move the thick  
brackets (%) to “To”.  
To clear a song  
1. Perform the procedure under “To start a song  
editor operation” on page E-76 to display the  
song editor menu, with the 0 located at  
“Clear”.  
2. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This displays the “Clear Song” screen.  
3. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify the  
• An asterisk (*) next to a song area number indicates  
that there is already data recorded in that area.  
song area number you want to clear.  
• An asterisk (*) next to a song area number indicates  
that there is already data recorded in that area.  
5. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify the  
song area number you want to copy to.  
6. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• If the copy destination song area does not contain  
recorded data, the copy operation is performed  
immediately.  
• If the copy destination song area already contains  
recorded data, the confirmation message shown below  
appears asking if you want to overwrite the existing  
data.  
• You can select “All” here to clear all songs.  
4. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
5. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to clear or  
the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
To copy a song from one area to another  
1. Perform the procedure under “To start a song  
editor operation” on page E-76 to display the  
song editor menu.  
Press the R-14 (YES) button to perform the copy  
operation and overwrite the existing song or the R-14  
(NO) button to cancel.  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“Copy” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays the “Copy Song” screen. At this time the  
thick brackets (%) will be located at the “Copy”  
setting.  
3. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify the  
song area number you want to copy from.  
E-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
To delete one or more measures from a song  
To insert blank measures into a song  
1. Perform the procedure under “To start a song  
editor operation” on page E-76 to display the  
song editor menu.  
1. Perform the procedure under “To start a song  
editor operation” on page E-76 to display the  
song editor menu.  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“DeleteMeas.” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“InsertMeas.” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This causes “Delete Measure” screen to appear. At this  
time the thick brackets (%) will be located at the  
“Measure” setting.  
• This causes “Insert Measure” screen to appear. At this  
time the thick brackets (%) will be located at the  
“Measure” setting.  
3. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify the  
3. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify the  
song measure number from which you want the  
insert to start.  
song measure you want to delete.  
4. Press the R-17 (y) button to move the thick  
brackets (%) to “Size”.  
4. Press the R-17 (y) button to move the thick  
brackets (%) to “Size”.  
5. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify the  
number of measures you want to insert.  
• For example, specifying 002 for “Measure” and 003 for  
“Size” will insert three blank measures in front of song  
measure 2.  
6. After everything is the way you want, press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
5. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify the  
7. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to insert  
or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
number of measures you want to delete.  
6. After everything is the way you want, press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
7. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to delete  
or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
E-78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
To rename a song  
To extract system track recorded content to  
track 04 through 07 or 09 through 16  
1. Perform the procedure under “To start a song  
editor operation” on page E-76 to display the  
song editor menu.  
As explained in detail under “Songs, tracks, and parts” (page  
E-65), the system track is an individual track, while the  
keyboard play and Auto Accompaniment data are recorded  
individually to multiple parts (A04 through A07, A09 through  
A16). The data of these parts is extracted to Tracks 04  
through 07 and 09 through 16, with one part corresponding  
individually to one track of data. This makes it easy to edit  
each accompaniment part individually.  
2. Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
“Rename” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays the “Rename” screen.  
A04  
A05  
A06  
A07  
A09  
A10  
A11  
A12  
A13  
A14  
A15  
A16  
B04  
B05  
B06  
B07  
B09  
B10  
B11  
B12  
B13  
B14  
B15  
B16  
Syste Track  
3. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the  
cursor to the name character position you want  
to change, and then use the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to select the character you want.  
• Performing this operation will delete all data currently  
recorded in the system track except for tempo data.  
• Performing this operation deletes all data currently  
recorded in Tracks 04 through 07 and 09 through 16,  
and overwrites it with the data in the system track.  
• See “Supported Input Characters” (page E-155) for  
information about the characters you can input for the  
name.  
• To input a space, press both of the R-14 (–, +) buttons  
at the same time.  
1. Perform the procedure under “To start a song  
editor operation” on page E-76 to display the  
song editor menu.  
4. After everything is the way you want, press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
5. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to rename  
the song or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“Extract” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays an “Extract” screen like the one shown  
below.  
3. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
4. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to start  
extraction or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
E-79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
To clear a single track  
Editing a Track  
1. Perform the procedure under “To start a track  
editor operation” on page E-80 to display the  
track editor menu.  
The following operations are supported during track (system  
track, Tracks 01 through 16) editing.  
• Clearing a single track  
• Copying one track to another track (Tracks 01 through 16  
only)  
2. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• Combining two tracks into a single track (Tracks 01 through  
16 only)  
• This causes the “Clear Track” screen to appear.  
To start a track editor operation  
1. Press the C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER) button to  
enter the song sequencer mode.  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-5 (EDIT) button to display  
the edit menu.  
3. Use the dial or R-17 (u, i) buttons to specify  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“TrackEdit” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
the track you want to clear.  
• A black box ( ) above a track number in the level  
meter indicates that there is already data recorded in  
that track.  
• You also can select a track using the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons.  
• This displays the track editor menu shown below.  
4. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
5. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to clear or  
the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
E-80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
To copy one track to another track  
(Tracks 01 through 16 only)  
To combine two tracks into a single track  
(Tracks 01 through 16 only)  
1. Perform the procedure under “To start a track  
editor operation” on page E-80 to display the  
track editor menu.  
1. In the song sequencer mode, use the R-17 (u,  
i) buttons to select the lower numbered track  
of those you want to combine.  
• As an example, we will combine Track 03 and Track 05  
into Track 06. Here, select Track 03.  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“Copy” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
2. Perform steps 2 and 3 of the procedure under  
“To start a track editor operation” on page E-80  
to display the track editor menu.  
• This causes the “Copy Track” screen to appear. At this  
time the thick brackets (%) will be located at the  
“Copy” setting.  
3. Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
“Merge” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
3. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify the  
track number you want to copy from.  
• This displays a “Merge Track” screen like the one  
shown below. At this time the thick brackets (%) will  
4. Press the R-17 (y) button to move the thick  
brackets (%) to “To”.  
be located at setting  
.
B
• An asterisk (*) next to a track number indicates that  
there is already data recorded in that track.  
A
B C  
5. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify the  
track number you want to copy to.  
6. After everything is the way you want, press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• If the copy destination track does not contain recorded  
data, the copy operation is performed immediately.  
• If the copy destination track already contains recorded  
data, the confirmation message shown below appears  
asking if you want to overwrite the existing data.  
: One of the tracks to be combined (The track you  
selected in step 1 is the initial default selection).  
: Other track to be combined.  
A
B
C
: Destination track of combined tracks.  
4. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify 05  
(Track 05) for  
.
B
• Changing the value of  
change.  
also causes the  
value to  
B
C
Press the R-14 (YES) button to perform the copy  
operation and overwrite the existing track or the R-14  
(NO) button to cancel.  
5. Press an R-17 (i or y) button to move the  
thick brackets (%) to  
.
C
6. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to specify 06  
(Track 06) for  
.
C
E-81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
7. After everything is the way you want, press the  
To start an event editor operation  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
1. Press the C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER) button to  
• If the destination track does not contain recorded data,  
combination of the tracks starts immediately.  
enter the song sequencer mode.  
• If the destination track already contains recorded data,  
the confirmation message shown below appears asking  
if you want to overwrite the existing data.  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-5 (EDIT) button to display  
the edit menu.  
3. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This displays the event editor screen shown below.  
Press the R-14 (YES) button to perform the process and  
overwrite the existing track or the R-14 (NO) button to  
cancel.  
• For information about how to use the event editor  
screen, see “Event Types and Screen Content” (page  
E-83).  
• Performing the above procedure does not clear the  
contents of the two source tracks. If you no longer need the  
content of a track, you can clear it using the procedure  
under “To clear a single track” (page E-80).  
4. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
• This displays the event editor menu shown below.  
Editing Events  
The song sequencer records all Digital Keyboard operations  
you perform while playing as “events”, which are the smallest  
unit of data that makes up a song. Playing a single note on the  
keyboard, for example, stores the following events: note start  
measure, beat, and track, note pitch, note length, and note  
intensity.  
The following operations are supported during event editing.  
• Deleting events  
• Inserting events  
• Copying events within a specific range to a desired location  
• Next, select the menu item that corresponds to the type  
of operation you want to perform. Details about each  
operation are provided in the procedures of this section.  
• Quantizing* note events  
• Deleting pitch bender events  
• Adjusting note event velocity values  
• Adjusting note event gate time values  
• Selecting the type of events that appear on the Event Editor  
screen (View Select)  
• Inserting or deleting beat events  
• Directly inputting note events (step input)  
* Quantize is an operation that automatically adjusts the  
note-on timing of a note event to match a reference note.  
E-82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
The following explains the meaning of each screen position.  
Event Types and Screen Content  
Number  
Description  
The event editor screen displays the individual events that  
make up a song as values and characters as shown in the  
sample screen below.  
For all event types, indicates the even location  
(timing) in the following format:  
measure:beat:tick. A “tick” is a time unit that is  
shorter than one beat. Song sequencer data uses  
96 ticks per beat (for 2/4 to 8/4) or 48 ticks per  
beat (for 2/8 to 16/8).  
Event being edited (selected event) (Center of screen)  
1
For almost all events, this position shows an  
abbreviation indicating the event type. “Bend” in  
display example (2) stands for “pitch bender  
event”. Note events (display example (1)) and  
chord events are different in that this position  
shows the event parameter (note name for a note  
event, root for a chord event) setting value.  
For information about what is displayed at this  
position and the corresponding event type, see  
the “Event Data List” (page E-84).  
2
Cursor (solid line)  
Events before (previous event) and after  
(following event) the current event  
This position shows parameter setting values that  
corresponds to the event type. When an event  
has multiple parameters, use the R-17 (u, i)  
buttons to move the cursor, which will scroll the  
display between the parameters. The name of the  
parameter at the current cursor position will be  
The event editor screen shows three events at one time. The  
event in the middle line is the selected event. You can change  
the value where the solid-line cursor is located. A broken line  
under a setting value indicates that the cursor can be moved  
to that value.  
3
4
displayed in position  
.
Reading Event Data  
Here we will use two types of event displays to explain how to  
read event data.  
4
This position indicates where the cursor is  
currently located as “MEAS.” (measure), “BEAT”  
(beat), or “TICK” (tick).  
• Example 1: Note event  
1
2
4
3
Cursor  
• Example 2: Pitch bender event  
1
2
4
3
Cursor  
E-83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
Event Data List  
The following table shows the event types that correspond to the abbreviations that appear on the display, as well as the  
parameters of each event type and setting ranges.  
• “ display” and “ display” in the table headings correspond to the  
,
2 4  
screen positions under “Reading Event Data” (page  
2
4
E-83).  
• “ display during insert” in the table headings indicates the event type name enclosed in thick brackets (%) when step 3 of  
2
insert event procedure under “To insert an event” (page E-89).  
System Track and Track 01 to 16 Common Events  
Event Type  
Event Name  
display during  
insert  
2
display  
Parameter Name  
Setting Range  
(Not editable)  
4
display  
2
TOP  
(song start point)  
NOTE  
GATE  
VEL  
Note name  
Gate time  
Velocity  
C- - C0 - G9*2  
00:00 - 99:95  
001 - 127  
*1  
Note  
[Note]  
Bend  
Mod  
Sus  
Pitch Bender  
Modulation*3  
[Bend]  
[Modulat]  
[Sustain]  
[Soft]  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
Pitch Bender  
Modulation  
Sustain Pedal  
Soft Pedal  
Sostenute Pedal  
Button On/Off  
–8192 - 0000 - +8191  
000 - 127  
Sustain Pedal  
Soft Pedal  
000 - 127  
Soft  
000 - 127  
Sost  
ModB  
END  
Sostenute Pedal  
Modulation Button  
(song end point)  
[Sostenu]  
[ModBttn]  
000 - 127  
on, oFF  
(Not editable)  
*1 A note event is not displayed as the event name at position , but rather as the note name (C4, etc.).  
2
*2 “C-” on the display indicates C-1 (one octave below C0).  
*3 This event can be added only with the operation under “To insert an event” (page E-89). It applies vibrato.  
Track 01 to 16 Events  
Event Type  
Event Name  
display during  
insert  
2
display  
Parameter Name  
Setting Range  
A:001 - L:100  
4
display  
2
TONE  
Vol  
Part Tone  
Part Volume  
[Tone]  
[Volume]  
[Pan]  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
Tone Number  
Part Volume  
000 - 127  
–64 - 00 - +63  
–24 - 00 - +24  
–99 - 00 - +99  
00 - 24  
Pan  
Part Pan  
Part Pan  
CTun  
FTun  
BndR  
RSnd  
CSnd  
SclE  
DspL  
Exp  
Part Coarse Tune  
Part Fine Tune  
Part Bend Range  
Part Reverb Send  
Part Chorus Send  
Part Scale Enable  
Part DSP Line  
Expression*4  
[CrsTune]  
[FinTune]  
[BendRng]  
[RevSend]  
[ChoSend]  
[ScaleEn]  
[DspLine]  
[Express]  
Part Coarse Tune  
Part Fine Tune  
Part Bend Range  
Part Reverb Send  
Part Chorus Send  
Part Scale Enable  
Part DSP Line  
Expression  
000 - 127  
000 - 127  
on, oFF  
on, oFF  
000 - 127  
*4 This event can be added only with the operation under “To insert an event” (page E-89). It changes the volume.  
E-84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
System Track Events  
Event Type  
display during  
insert  
2
display  
Parameter Name  
Setting Range  
A:001 - L:100  
4
display  
TnU1  
Event Name  
UPPER 1 Tone  
UPPER 2 Tone  
LOWER Tone  
2
[Tone_U1]  
[Tone_U2]  
[Tone_Lo]  
[Tone_Hm]  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
Tone Number  
Tone Number  
Tone Number  
Tone Number  
Root  
TnU2  
A:001 - L:100  
A:001 - L:100  
A:001 - L:100  
TnLo  
TnHm  
Auto Harmonize Tone  
ROOT  
TYPE  
CVEL  
VALU  
VALU  
C - B  
*2  
*1  
Chord  
[Chord]  
Chord type  
Chord velocity  
Rhythm Number  
Rhythm controller  
000 - 127  
RHY  
Rctl  
Rhythm  
[Rhythm]  
[RhyCtrl]  
A:001 - F:100  
*3  
Rhythm Controller  
PERC, DRUM, BASS,  
CHD1 - CHD5  
PART  
Part  
Accompaniment Part  
On/Off  
APrt  
[AcmpPrt]  
VALU  
VALU  
PART  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
On/Off  
Layer On/Off  
Part  
on, oFF  
Layr  
Shft  
Splt  
Layer On/Off  
Octave Shift  
[Layer]  
on, oFF  
UPP1, UPP2, LOWR  
–2 - 0 - +2  
on, oFF  
[OctShft]  
Octave Shift  
Split On/Off  
Tempo  
Split On/Off  
Tempo  
[Split]  
[Tempo]  
[SplitPt]  
TMPO  
SplP  
30 - 255  
C- - C0 - G9*4  
Split Point  
Split Point  
Auto Harmonize/  
Arpeggiator  
Auto Harmonize/  
Arpeggiator  
HmAp  
[HarmArp]  
VALU  
oFF, 001 - 162  
ApHd  
ApSp  
ApPt  
Revb  
Chrs  
DSP  
Arpeggiator Hold  
Arpeggiator Speed  
Arpeggiator Part  
Reverb  
[ArpHold]  
[ArpSpd]  
[ArpPart]  
[Reverb]  
[Chorus]  
[DSP]  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
NOTE  
Cent  
Arpeggiator Hold  
Arpeggiator Speed  
Arpeggiator Part  
Reverb  
on, oFF  
1, 2, 2S, 3, 4, 4S, 6, 8  
UPPER, LOWER  
oFF, 01 - 10  
1 - 5  
Chorus  
Chorus  
DSP  
DSP  
ton, 001 - 200  
C - B  
Key  
Scal  
Scale  
[Scale]  
Cent  
–99 - 00 - +99  
UPP1, UPP2, LOWR,  
HARM  
PART  
VALU  
PART  
VALU  
PART  
VALU  
PART  
VALU  
PART  
VALU  
Part  
Part Volume  
Part  
Vol  
Part Volume  
[Volume]  
000 - 127  
UPP1, UPP2, LOWR,  
HARM  
Pan  
Part Pan  
[Pan]  
Part Pan  
–64 - 00 - +63  
UPP1, UPP2, LOWR,  
HARM  
Part  
CTun  
FTun  
BndR  
Part Coarse Tune  
Part Fine Tune  
Part Bend Range  
[CrsTune]  
[FinTune]  
[BendRng]  
Part Coarse Tune  
Part  
–24 - 00 - +24  
UPP1, UPP2, LOWR,  
HARM  
Part Fine Tune  
Part  
–99 - 00 - +99  
UPP1, UPP2, LOWR,  
HARM  
Part Bend Range  
00 - 24  
E-85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
Event Type  
display during  
insert  
2
display  
Parameter Name  
Setting Range  
4
display  
Event Name  
2
UPP1, UPP2, LOWR,  
HARM  
PART  
VALU  
PART  
VALU  
PART  
Part  
Part Reverb Send  
Part  
RSnd  
Part Reverb Send  
[RevSend]  
[ChoSend]  
[DspLine]  
000 - 127  
UPP1, UPP2, LOWR,  
HARM  
CSnd  
DspL  
Part Chorus Send  
Part Chorus Send  
Part  
000 - 127  
UPP1, UPP2, LOWR,  
HARM  
Part DSP Line  
VALU  
VALU  
VALU  
Part DSP Line  
Accomp volume  
Accomp Scale  
on, oFF  
000 - 127  
on, oFF  
AVol  
AScl  
Accomp Volume*5  
Accomp Scale*6  
[AcmpVol]  
[AcmpScl]  
*1 A chord event is not displayed as the event name at position , but rather as the chord root (C, etc.)  
2
*2 See “Fingering Guide” on (page E-155).  
*3 Intro: intro pattern, norml: normal pattern, Vari: variation pattern, nFlOn: normal fill-in on, nFloF: normal fill-in off,  
vFlOn: variation fill-in on, vFloF: variation fill-in off, Endin: ending pattern.  
*4 “C-” on the display indicates C-1 (one octave below C0).  
*5 This setting corresponds to the function menu “AccompVol.” item (page E-128).  
*6 For details, see “Specifying whether the Current Scale Settings Should be Applied to Auto Accompaniment (Accomp Scale)”  
(page E-25).  
To select a track for editing  
1. Perform steps 1 to 3 of the procedure under “To start an event editor operation” on page E-82 to display  
the event editor screen.  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION) button, use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to select the track you  
want to edit.  
To play back a song from the event editor screen (Quick Play)  
1. Perform steps 1 to 3 of the procedure under “To start an event editor operation” on page E-82 to display  
the event editor screen.  
2. Press the L-17 (START/STOP) button.  
• This starts playback of the song being edited from the first measure where the cursor is currently located.  
• Playback stops automatically when it reaches the end of a song. To stop playback part way through, press the L-17  
(START/STOP) button.  
E-86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
To edit an existing event  
To select the types of events that appear on  
the Event Editor screen (View Select)  
1. Display the event editor screen of the track that  
includes the event you want to edit.  
1. Perform the procedure under “To start an event  
• See “To select a track for editing” (page E-86).  
editor operation” on page E-82.  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the  
2. Use R-17 (i) button to display page three of  
the event editor menu, with the 0 located at  
“ViewSelect”.  
cursor to the event you want to edit.  
• You can use the L-15 (dFF) and L-14 (sREW)  
buttons to move the cursor by measure-by-measure.  
3. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
3. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the  
cursor, and then use the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to change the value at the cursor  
position.  
• This displays the “View Select” screen.  
• The cursor flashes during a value change operation.  
• During note event recording, you can change the pitch  
of a note by pressing a keyboard key. If the cursor is  
located at the “VEL” position, the velocity value will  
change at the same time as the note pitch.  
4. To apply the changed value, press the R-16  
(ENTER) button.  
4. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0  
between the setting items, and the dial or R-14  
(–, +) buttons to toggle the currently selected  
setting between “on” (shown) and “oFF”  
(hidden).  
• This causes the cursor to stop flashing.  
To delete an individual event  
1. Display the event editor screen of the track that  
includes the events you want to delete.  
• The table below shows the event that corresponds to  
each setting item.  
• See “To select a track for editing” (page E-86).  
Setting Item  
Note  
Corresponding Event  
Note event  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the  
cursor to the event you want to delete.  
PitchBend  
Pedal  
Pitch Bend event  
Sustain, soft, sostenute events  
Rhythm event  
3. Press the C-10 (DELETE) button.  
• The event at the current cursor position will be deleted  
Rhythm  
Chord  
as soon as you press the C-10 (DELETE) button.  
Chord event  
Tempo  
Tone  
Tempo event  
Tone event  
Mixer  
Mixer event (excluding Tone event)  
All other events besides those above.  
Others  
• For information about each event, see “Event Types  
and Screen Content” (page E-83).  
5. Press the R-15 (EXIT) button to apply the  
settings and exit the “View Select” screen.  
E-87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
3. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button to display  
the event editor menu.  
To delete all events in a track  
1. Display the event editor screen of the track that  
includes the events you want to delete.  
4. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“Delete” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• See “To select a track for editing” (page E-86).  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button to display  
the event editor menu.  
• This displays the “Delete” screen.  
5. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting in the thick brackets (%) to “Locator”.  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“Delete” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays a range specification screen like the one  
shown below.  
• If you have already specified a range using the locator  
screen (page E-75), that range will be displayed on the  
range specification screen.  
• This displays the “Delete” screen.  
4. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting in the thick brackets (%) to “All”, and  
then press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
Range end point  
Range start point  
6. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the  
cursor, and then use the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to change the value at the cursor  
position.  
5. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to delete  
or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
• The event located at the timing specified by the range  
end point will not be deleted.  
To delete all events in a specific range of a  
track  
7. After everything is the way you want, press the  
1. Display the event editor screen of the track that  
includes the events you want to delete.  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• See “To select a track for editing” (page E-86).  
8. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to delete  
or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
2. If required, you can perform a song playback  
operation at this time to check the range you  
want to select for deletion.  
• See “To play back a song from the event editor screen  
(Quick Play)” (page E-86).  
E-88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
5. After everything is the way you want, press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
To insert an event  
1. Display the event editor screen of the track  
where you want to insert the event.  
• This inserts the specified event.  
• See “To select a track for editing” (page E-86).  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the  
cursor to the position where you want to insert  
an event.  
• The new event will be inserted at the same timing as  
the event where the cursor is located. You can fine tune  
the timing after inserting the new event.  
3. Press the C-11 (INSERT) button.  
6. Adjust the settings of the event as desired.  
• This inserts the event at the specified location and  
displays a screen like the one shown below.  
• Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the cursor, and  
then use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
value at the cursor position. The cursor flashes during a  
value change operation.  
Note type (for note event only)  
• For information about data types and setting value  
ranges for events that can be edited, see “Event Types  
and Screen Content” (page E-83).  
7. To apply the event data, press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This causes the cursor to stop flashing.  
• You also can perform the operation in step 3 by moving the  
0 to “Insert” on the event editor menu and then pressing  
the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
Event type name  
4. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select an  
event type.  
To copy the events within a specific range to  
a desired location  
• For information about events that can be specified, see  
“Event Types and Screen Content” (page E-83).  
• When a note event is specified as the event type,  
specify the note type (note length) using the buttons  
shown in the table below. You specify the pitch of the  
note in step 6 of this procedure.  
1. Display the event editor screen of the track that  
contains the events you want to copy.  
• See “To select a track for editing” (page E-86).  
To specify this type of  
Press this button:  
note:  
2. If required, you can perform a song playback  
operation to check the range you want to select  
for copying and the copy location.  
Whole  
Half  
R-1 (5)  
R-2 (1)  
Quarter  
Eighth  
R-3 (2)  
1
2
R-7 (6)  
R-8 (7)  
R-9 (8)  
R-4 (•)  
Sixteenth  
Thirty-second  
Dotted*  
018:01:00  
020:01:00  
024:01:00  
• See “To play back a song from the event editor screen  
(Quick Play)” (page E-86).  
Triplet*  
R-10 (,)  
* For dotted notes and triplets, first select the note and then  
add the dot or triplet. To specify a dotted quarter note, for  
example, press the R-3 (2) button and then the R-4 (•)  
button.  
E-89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
3. Press the C-12 (COPY) button.  
To quantize an individual note event  
• This displays the “Copy” screen.  
• If you have already specified a range using the locator  
screen (page E-75), that range will be displayed on the  
range specification screen.  
1. Display the event editor screen of the track that  
includes the event you want to quantize.  
• See “To select a track for editing” (page E-86).  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the  
cursor to the event you want to quantize.  
3. Press the C-13 (QUANTIZE) button.  
• This displays the “Quantize” screen.  
Copy destination point  
2
Copy source range (start point - end point)  
1
4. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the  
cursor, and then use the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to change the value at the cursor  
position.  
4. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting in the thick brackets (%) to “Cursor”.  
5. After everything is the way you want, press the  
5. Specify the note you want to use as the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
quantize reference note.  
6. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to copy or  
the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
To specify this type of  
Press this button:  
note:  
Quarter  
Eighth  
R-3 (2)  
R-7 (6)  
• Pressing the R-14 (YES) button executes the copy  
operation. The message “Complete” appears and the  
display returns to the “Copy” screen after the copy is  
complete.  
Sixteenth  
Thirty-second  
Triplet*  
R-8 (7)  
R-9 (8)  
• At this time, the “ Copy destination position” value on  
2
R-10 (,)  
the locator screen moves forward by the length  
specified by “ Copy source range”.  
1
* For a triplet, first select the note and then add the triplet. To  
specify a triplet made up of quarter notes, for example,  
press the R-3 (2) button and then the R-10 (,) button.  
1
2
018:01:00  
020:01:00  
024:01:00  
026:01:00  
6. After everything is the way you want, press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
If you want to continue by copying the same copy  
source range to another location, repeat steps 5 and 6  
again.  
• This performs quantization and returns to the event  
editor screen.  
7. To return to the event editor screen, press the  
R-15 (EXIT) button.  
E-90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
4. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting in the thick brackets (%) to “Locator”.  
To quantize all note events in a track  
1. Display the event editor screen of the track you  
want to quantize.  
• This displays a range specification screen like the one  
shown below.  
• If you have already specified a range using the locator  
screen (page E-75), that range will be displayed on the  
range specification screen.  
• See “To select a track for editing” (page E-86).  
2. Press the C-13 (QUANTIZE) button.  
• This displays the “Quantize” screen.  
3. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting in the thick brackets (%) to “All”.  
4. Perform step 5 under “To quantize an individual  
note event” on page E-90.  
5. Press the L-17 (START/STOP) button when you  
want to play back with quantization applied.  
• Note that the actual data still has not been changed yet.  
Range start point  
Range end point  
6. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
5. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the  
cursor, and then use the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to change the value at the cursor  
position.  
7. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to  
quantize or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
6. Perform step 5 under “To quantize an individual  
To quantize all note events within specific  
range of a track  
note event” on page E-90.  
7. Press the L-17 (START/STOP) button when you  
want to play back with quantization applied.  
• Note that the actual data still has not been changed yet.  
1. Display the event editor screen of the track that  
includes the events you want to quantize.  
• See “To select a track for editing” (page E-86).  
8. After everything is the way you want, press the  
2. If required, you can perform a song playback  
operation at this time to check the range you  
want to select for quanitization.  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
9. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to  
quantize or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
• See “To play back a song from the event editor screen  
(Quick Play)” (page E-86).  
3. Press the C-13 (QUANTIZE) button.  
• This displays the “Quantize” screen.  
E-91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
To delete all pitch bender events within a specific  
range of a track  
Deleting Pitch Bender Events  
You can use the procedures in this section to delete all pitch  
bender events from a track or from a specific range in a track.  
1. Display the event editor screen of the track  
whose pitch bender events you want to delete.  
• See “To select a track for editing” (page E-86).  
• To delete individual pitch bender events, perform the  
operation under “To delete an individual event” (page  
E-87).  
2. If required, you can perform a song playback  
operation at this time to check the range you  
want to select for deletion.  
• After deleting the pitch bender events in one track from  
Track 01 through Track 16, you can overdub new pitch  
bender (PITCH BEND wheel (S-1)) operations for that  
track. To do so, use the procedure under “To record to  
Tracks 01 through 16” (page E-68), and select “OVDB”  
(Overdub) for the “RecType” setting in step 6-(5).  
• Since “OVDB” cannot be selected for “RecType” when  
recording to the system track, you will not be able to  
overdub pitch bender operations after deleting pitch bender  
events from the system track. You can use the procedure  
under “To insert an event” (page E-89) to insert pitch  
bender events.  
• See “To play back a song from the event editor screen  
(Quick Play)” (page E-86).  
3. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button to display  
the event editor menu.  
4. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“DeleteBender” and then press the R-16  
(ENTER) button.  
• This causes “Delete Bender” screen to appear.  
To delete all pitch bender events in a track  
5. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting in the thick brackets (%) to “Locator”.  
1. Display the event editor screen of the track  
whose pitch bender events you want to delete.  
• See “To select a track for editing” (page E-86).  
• This displays a range specification screen like the one  
shown below.  
• If you have already specified a range using the locator  
screen (page E-75), that range will be displayed on the  
range specification screen.  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button to display  
the event editor menu.  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“DeleteBender” and then press the R-16  
(ENTER) button.  
• This causes “Delete Bender” screen to appear.  
Range start point  
Range end point  
6. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the  
cursor, and then use the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to change the value at the cursor  
position.  
4. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting in the thick brackets (%) to “All”, and  
then press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
7. After everything is the way you want, press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
5. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to delete  
or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
8. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to delete  
or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
E-92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
6. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
To adjust the velocity value of a note event  
• This will display the setting screen like the one shown  
below.  
1. Display the event editor screen of the track you  
want to edit.  
• See “To select a track for editing” (page E-86).  
2. Depending on the type of adjustment you want  
make, perform one of the operations below.  
To adjust this:  
Do this:  
Individual note event  
On the event editor screen,  
move the cursor to the note  
event you want to adjust and  
then advance to step 3.  
• The following explains the meanings and setting ranges  
of the on-screen items. The settings marked with an  
asterisk (*) in the “Setting Range” column are initial  
defaults.  
All note events in a track  
Advance to step 3.  
Advance to step 3.  
Note events within a  
Item name  
Description  
Setting Range  
specific range in a track  
Fix  
Specifies a fixed value as the  
velocity value.  
oFF*, 001 to 127  
(Fixed value)  
3. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button to display  
the event editor menu.  
Select “oFF” for this setting to  
adjust based on the current  
velocity value of each note  
event.  
Rate  
(Velocity Rate)  
These settings are enabled  
only when the “oFF” is selected 200%  
for the “Fix” setting. They  
000% to 100%* to  
4. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“VelocityMod.” and then press the R-16  
(ENTER) button.  
change the velocity value of  
each note event according to  
the mathematical expression  
(decimal parts cut off) shown  
below. 1 is used when the value  
produced by the expression is  
less than 1, and 127 is used  
when it is greater than 127.  
• This displays the “Velocity Modify” screen.  
Offset  
(Velocity Offset)  
–126 to 000* to  
+126  
(Current velocity)  
setting) + (Offset setting)  
X
(Rate  
7. To change the setting to the desired value,  
press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
5. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
mode indicated in the thick brackets (%).  
8. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to execute  
the adjustment or the R-14 (NO) button to  
cancel.  
To adjust this:  
Individual note event  
All note events in a track  
Select this mode:  
Cursor  
All  
Note events within a specific range Locator  
in a track  
• While the “Locator” mode is selected, use the R-17 (u,  
i) buttons, the dial, or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
specify the range whose note event velocity value you  
want to adjust.  
E-93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
To adjust the gate time value of a note event  
To delete a beat event  
1. Perform steps 1 through 5 under “To adjust the  
velocity value of a note event” on page E-93. In  
step 4, select “GatetimeMod.” instead of  
“VelocityMod.”.  
1. Perform the procedure under “To start an event  
editor operation” on page E-82 to display the  
event editor menu.  
2. Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
“Beat” and then press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This displays the “Beat” screen.  
2. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This will display the setting screen like the one shown  
below.  
• The following explains the meanings and setting ranges  
of the on-screen items. The settings marked with an  
asterisk (*) in the “Setting Range” column are initial  
defaults.  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the  
cursor to the beat event you want to delete.  
4. Press the C-10 (DELETE) button.  
Item name  
Description  
Setting Range  
• The event at the current cursor position will be deleted  
as soon as you press the C-10 (DELETE) button.  
Fix  
Specifies a fixed value as the  
time gate value. 99:95 stands  
for quarter note 99 beats, 95  
ticks.  
oFF*,  
00:00 to 99:95  
(Fixed value)  
Select “oFF” for this setting to  
adjust based on the current  
gate time value of each note  
event.  
Rate  
(Gate Time  
Rate)  
These settings are enabled  
only when the “oFF” is selected 200%  
for the “Fix” setting. They  
000% to 100%* to  
change the gate time value of  
each note event according to  
the mathematical expression  
(decimal parts cut off) shown  
below. 00:00 is used when the  
Offset  
(Gate Time  
Offset)  
–9:95 to 0:00* to  
+9:95  
value produced by the  
expression is less than 00:00,  
and 99:95 is used when it is  
greater than 99:95.  
(Current gate time)  
setting) + (Offset setting)  
X
(Rate  
3. To change the setting to the desired value,  
press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
4. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to execute  
the adjustment or the R-14 (NO) button to  
cancel.  
E-94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
To perform step input  
To insert a beat event  
1. Perform steps 1 and 2 under “To delete a beat  
1. Display the event editor screen of the track  
where you want to perform step input.  
• See “To select a track for editing” (page E-86).  
event” (page E-94).  
2. Move the cursor to the beat event that comes  
immediately before the location where you want  
to insert a new beat event.  
2. Press the C-14 (STEP) button.  
• This will display a step screen like the one shown  
below. The cursor is always flashing during step input.  
3. Press the C-11 (INSERT) button.  
• This will insert a new beat event into the next measure  
after the cursor position you selected in step 2, which  
does not contain a beat event. If, for example, there are  
beat events already in measures 16 and 17, selecting  
the beat event in measure 16 with the cursor and  
pressing the C-11 (INSERT) button will insert a new  
beat event into measure 18.  
4. Change the beat event measure and beat as  
Cursor (flashing)  
required.  
• Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the cursor, and  
then use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
value at the cursor position. The cursor flashes during a  
value change operation. Pressing the R-16 (ENTER)  
button applies the setting and causes the cursor to stop  
flashing.  
3. Configure step input settings.  
(1) While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION) button,  
press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
This displays the input menu shown below.  
5. To return to the event editor screen, press the  
R-15 (EXIT) button.  
Directly Inputting Note Events  
(Step Input)  
Step input is an event editor function. You can use step input  
to specify the length and pitch of each individual note (note  
event). In the system track, you also can perform step input of  
Auto Accompaniment chords (chord events) as well.  
(2) Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to the  
setting item you want to change.  
(3) Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting value.  
For information about the meanings and setting ranges  
of the on-screen items, see “Input Menu Setting Items”  
(page E-96).  
• Performing step input into a track that already contains  
recorded data will not delete the existing data. This means  
you can use step input to add to existing recorded data.  
(4) Press the R-15 (EXIT) button to exit the menu.  
4. Use the L-15 (dFF) and L-14 (sREW)  
buttons to move the cursor to the location from  
which you want to perform step input.  
• The cursor will move in one-measure steps.  
E-95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Song Sequencer  
5. Use buttons R-1 (5) to R-4 (•) and buttons R-7 (6) to R-10 (,) to specify the length of the note you want  
to input.  
• For information about how to specify note lengths, see step 4 under “To insert an event” (page E-89).  
• You can perform the following operations during step input to insert ties and rests.  
To do this:  
Perform this operation:  
Tie the note at the  
1. At the current cursor position, specify the length of the note you want to tie with the immediately  
preceding note event.  
2. Press the R-11 (.) button.  
current cursor position  
with the note event  
immediately before it  
• This adds the length of the note you specified in step 1 to the length of the note immediately  
preceding it. At this time, the cursor will move forward by the timing of the added amount.  
Preceding note event  
Current cursor position  
Cursor position after process  
A
B
C
6 2  
6 2 2  
C
A B  
A
Insert a rest before the  
current cursor position  
1. At the current cursor position, specify a note that is the same length as the rest you want to insert.  
2. Press the R-5 (REST) button.  
• The cursor will move forward by the length of the note you specified in step 1.  
6 2  
6 2  
C
Current cursor position  
Cursor position after process  
B
C
B
6. Press the keyboard key that corresponds to the note you want to input.  
• The note is input as soon as you press the keyboard key, and the cursor will move by the length you specified in step 5 to the  
next measure:beat:tick. From there you can input the next note, if you want.  
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to input the notes you want.  
• If you want to input a series of notes of the same length, skip step 5 and perform step 6 only.  
8. After inputting all of the notes you want, press the R-15 (EXIT) or R-17 (t, y) buttons.  
• This returns to the event editor screen.  
Input Menu Setting Items  
Pressing the C-17 (MENU) button while holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION) button during step input will display the input menu.  
The following explains the meanings and setting ranges of the input menu items. The settings marked with an asterisk (*) in the  
“Setting Range” column are initial defaults.  
Item name  
GateRate  
Description  
Setting Range  
Specifies the gate rate as a percentage of the actually input gate length for the 001% to 080%* to 100%  
length (gate length) of the note event that was specified using buttons R-1 (5)  
through R-4 (•) and R-7 (6) through R-10 (,). Specifying a GateRate of  
080% and inputting a quarter note (96 ticks), for example, will result in a GATE  
setting of 00:76 (96 X 0.8 = 76.8, cut off to 76).  
(Gate Rate)  
Velocity  
(Velocity)  
Specifies the velocity value of an input note event or chord event. Specifying  
“KeyOn” inputs a velocity value in accordance with applied key pressure.  
KeyOn, 001 to 100* to 127  
SysTrack  
(System Track)  
Selects either note event input or chord event input when inputting to the  
system track.  
note*, Chord  
E-96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
L-9  
C-4  
C-7  
R-13  
R-14  
R-15  
R-16  
R-17  
L-13  
L-14 L-16  
L-15 L-17  
C-10  
C-17  
Recordable Data  
About the Pattern Sequencer  
You can use the pattern sequencer to create accompaniment  
patterns that sound while using the Digital Keyboard’s Auto  
Accompaniment function and store them as user rhythms.  
You can use the pattern sequencer to record keyboard play  
(note data), PITCH BEND wheel (S-1) operations, and S-2  
(MODULATION) button operations.  
Instrument Part Editing and Rec Areas  
Rhythms, Accompaniment Patterns, and  
Instrument Parts  
As a general rule, pattern sequencer editing operations are  
performed on an instrument part basis. The pattern sequencer  
maintains special memory areas called “rec areas” for each  
instrument part during rhythm editing. These areas are used  
when recording keyboard notes.  
When editing with the pattern sequencer, there may be  
previously existing rhythm data remaining for some of the  
instrument parts, which will make it impossible to use the rec  
areas. The status of an instrument part that still contains  
previously existing rhythm data is “Fix Data”.  
Each of the Digital Keyboard’s rhythms provides six different  
accompaniment patterns named INTRO, NORMAL, NORMAL  
FILL-IN, VARIATION, VARIATION FILL-IN, and ENDING.  
Each accompaniment pattern can be made up of eight  
instrument parts (drums, percussion, bass, and chord 1  
through chord 5).  
The overall configuration of a single rhythm is as shown  
below.  
You can use the pattern sequencer screen to check whether  
the currently selected instrument part is in the rec area or if it  
is “Fix Data”.  
Rhythm  
INTRO  
Drums  
NORMAL  
Drums  
NORMAL FILL-IN  
Drums  
You can display the pattern sequencer screen by pressing the  
C-4 (PATTERN SEQUENCER) button. This will display the  
pattern sequencer editing screen for the currently selected  
rhythm (preset rhythm or previously stored user rhythm). The  
initial screen shows the drum part of the NORMAL  
accompaniment pattern of the rhythm being edited. Note “Fix  
Data” in the lower left corner. This is the current status of the  
currently displayed instrument part.  
Percussion  
Bass  
Percussion  
Bass  
Percussion  
Bass  
Chord 1 to Chord 5  
Chord 1 to Chord 5  
Chord 1 to Chord 5  
VARIATION  
Drums  
VARIATION FILL-IN  
Drums  
ENDING  
Drums  
Percussion  
Bass  
Percussion  
Percussion  
Bass  
Bass  
Chord 1 to Chord 5  
Chord 1 to Chord 5  
Chord 1 to Chord 5  
The pattern sequencer is a function that allows editing and  
creation of the various accompaniment patterns that make up  
a single rhythm, part-by-part. You can record each part of all  
of the accompaniment patterns from scratch to create a  
completely original new rhythm. You also can partially edit an  
existing rhythm (by, for example, editing only one of the parts  
of an accompaniment pattern) or simply modify its mixer  
settings if you want.  
E-97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
The following describes each of the different instrument part  
statuses that appear in the lower left corner of the screen.  
Creating a User Rhythm  
This section explains the various methods you can use to  
create user rhythms.  
When this is  
It means this:  
displayed:  
Fix Data  
(Fixed Data)  
Instrument part data from a preset  
rhythm or user rhythm. The only  
settings that can be edited for an  
instrument part with this status are  
mixer settings. Real-time recording of  
keyboard notes and event editing are  
not allowed.  
Editing One or More Parts of an Existing Rhythm  
With this procedure, you edit an existing preset rhythm or  
previously stored user rhythm to create a new rhythm.  
With this method, you can select and edit (or record anew)  
specific parts of an existing accompaniment pattern and store  
the result.  
The following is the general flow for this method.  
Recorded Data  
(Recorded Data)  
Instrument part is being edited using a  
rec area, and recorded data is  
contained in the rec area. Mixer  
settings, real-time recording of  
keyboard notes, and event editing are  
allowed for an instrument part with this  
status.  
Check the content of the rhythm you will edit and  
determine how (what part of what accompaniment  
pattern*) you will edit it.  
Use the rec menu to configure settings related to  
accompaniment pattern recording.  
Empty  
(No data)  
Instrument part is being edited using a  
rec area, but there is no recorded data  
in the rec area (rec area empty). Mixer  
settings, real-time recording of  
keyboard notes, and event editing are  
allowed for an instrument part with this  
status.  
Display the instrument part for the accompaniment  
pattern you want to edit and then configure the desired  
mixer settings and record keyboard notes.  
After editing is complete, store the rhythm as a user  
rhythm.  
* You cannot edit the INTRO or ENDING of an  
accompaniment pattern of an existing rhythm.  
User Rhythm Numbers  
Rhythm areas numbered F:001 through F:100 are for storage  
of user rhythms. You can have up to 100 user rhythms stored  
in memory at one time. You can recall a stored user rhythm by  
pressing the L-9 ([F] USER RHYTHMS) button. See “Playing  
an Auto Accompaniment” (page E-26) for more information.  
For full details about this procedure, see “To rehearse before  
editing an existing rhythm” (page E-99) and “To edit an  
existing rhythm” (page E-102).  
E-98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
Replacing the Accompaniment Patterns of an  
Existing Rhythm with New Recordings  
To rehearse before editing an existing  
rhythm  
With this procedure, you re-record one or more of the  
accompaniment patterns of an existing preset rhythm or  
previously stored user rhythm to create a new rhythm.  
In this case, you clear all of the rec areas included in an  
accompaniment pattern and then create new recordings of  
each part of the accompaniment pattern. Use this method, for  
example, when you want to create only a new INTRO  
accompaniment pattern for an existing rhythm.  
1. Select the rhythm you want to edit in order to  
create your user rhythm.  
2. Press the C-4 (PATTERN SEQUENCER) button.  
The following is the general flow for this method.  
Clear all of the rec areas of the accompaniment pattern  
you want to record anew.  
• This displays the pattern sequencer screen.  
Currently selected instrument part  
Use the rec menu to configure settings related to  
accompaniment pattern recording.  
On the edit menu, configure accompaniment pattern  
number of measure and beat settings.  
Sequentially record each of the parts.  
After editing is complete, store the entire rhythm as a  
user rhythm.  
For full details about this procedure, see “To create a new  
accompaniment pattern” (page E-104).  
Currently selected accompaniment pattern  
Newly Recording All Accompaniment Patterns of  
a Rhythm  
With this procedure, you create a new rhythm from scratch,  
without using an existing rhythm.  
Currently selected instrument part status  
See “Instrument Part Editing and Rec Areas” (page E-97).  
The following is the general flow for this method.  
Clear all of the rec areas included in the currently  
selected rhythm.  
Use the rec menu to configure settings related to  
accompaniment pattern recording.  
On the edit menu, configure accompaniment pattern  
number of measure and beat settings.  
Sequentially record each of the parts of each  
accompaniment pattern.  
After editing is complete, store the rhythm as a user  
rhythm.  
For full details about this procedure, see “To create a new  
rhythm from scratch” (page E-106).  
E-99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
3. Use buttons L-13 (INTRO) through L-16  
(SYNCHRO/ENDING) to select the  
(3) Press the R-14 (–, +) buttons at the same time.  
• This changes the “Part” setting to “Sol”, which  
indicates that the selected instrument part will be  
sounded alone (solo).  
accompaniment pattern you want to play. If you  
want to play the INTRO accompaniment pattern,  
for example, press the L-13 (INTRO) button.  
• Each press of the L-14 (NORMAL/FILL-IN) button  
toggles between NORMAL and NORMAL FILL-IN, and  
each press of the L-15 (VARIATION/FILL-IN) button  
toggles between VARIATION and VARIATION FILL-IN.  
• The indicator for the currently selected accompaniment  
pattern will flash on the display.  
• To return all parts to their original (non-solo) status,  
press the R-14 (–, +) buttons at the same time or  
press either of the R-17 (u, i) buttons.  
6. Repeat steps 3 through 5 as required to  
determine which accompaniment patterns you  
want to edit and which parts you want to  
re-record.  
Selecting this accompaniment Causes this indicator  
pattern:  
to flash:  
• If you want to proceed directly into the editing operation  
from this point, perform the procedure under “To edit an  
existing rhythm” (page E-102). If you do, you can either  
allow the accompaniment pattern to continue to play, or  
you can stop playback by pressing the L-17 (START/  
STOP) button.  
INTRO  
E
NORMAL  
F
NORMAL FILL-IN  
VARIATION  
F G  
H
VARIATION FILL-IN  
ENDING  
G H  
J
7. To exit this procedure without going directly  
into the editing operation, press the C-4  
(PATTERN SEQUENCER) button.  
4. Press the L-17 (START/STOP) button.  
• The specified accompaniment pattern plays back in a  
loop. To sound bass and chord notes, play a chord on  
the chord keyboard.  
• If the accompaniment pattern is playing when you press  
the C-4 (PATTERN SEQUENCER) button, playback  
will stop, the display will exit the pattern sequencer  
screen, and the screen that was displayed in step 1 of  
this procedure will appear.  
• Each press of the L-17 (START/STOP) button during  
the following operation starts or stops playback.  
5. If you want to hear the notes of a particular  
instrument part played alone, perform the  
following steps.  
(1) Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to select the  
instrument part you want to hear played alone.  
• The name of the instrument part you select will  
appear on the display.  
Selecting this  
instrument part:  
Causes this name to  
appear on the display:  
Percussion  
PERC  
Drums  
DRUM  
Bass  
BASS  
Chord 1 to Chord 5  
CHORD1 to CHORD5  
(2) Press the C-7 (MIXER) button and then press the  
R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to “Part”.  
E-100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
Display:  
Item name  
Setting  
Range  
To configure pattern rec settings (Rec Menu)  
Description  
1. While the pattern sequencer screen is  
PlayChord:  
Playback  
Chords  
Starting recording of an  
oFF, C*,  
C7, Cm  
displayed, press the C-6 (RECORD) button.  
accompaniment pattern starts  
repeat playback of all the parts of  
the pattern, except for the part  
being recorded. During such  
repeat playback, you can use this  
setting to specify the chord type to  
be used for playback by bass and  
chord parts. Available settings are  
“C” (C major), “C7” (C 7th), and  
“Cm” (C minor). Selecting “oFF”  
turns off bass and chord part  
notes.  
• The button will start to flash and the Digital Keyboard  
will enter record standby.  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
• This displays a rec menu screen like the one shown  
below.  
Metronome: Specifies whether the metronome oFF*, on  
Metronome  
should sound (on) or not sound  
(oFF) during recording.  
4. Press the R-15 (EXIT) button to exit the rec  
menu.  
• This returns to the pattern sequencer screen.  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to select one of  
the items described in the table below and then  
use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting.  
5. Press the C-6 (RECORD) button.  
• This exits record standby, which will cause the button to  
change from lit to unlit.  
• The settings marked with an asterisk (*) in the “Setting  
Range” column are initial defaults.  
Display:  
Item name  
Setting  
Range  
Description  
Quantize:  
Quantize  
Specify either recording of notes in oFF*, 4, 8,  
the timing they are played on the  
keyboard (oFF) or automatic  
alignment of notes with a base  
note (setting other than oFF).  
Selecting a value specifies the  
length of each note. “4” specifies  
quarter notes, while a “T” setting  
specifies triplets.  
8T, 16, 16T  
Precount:  
Pre-count  
Specifies whether a precount  
should sound before recording  
starts after the L-17 (START/  
STOP) button is pressed in record  
standby. Selecting “1” sounds a  
one-measure precount, while “2”  
sounds a two-measure precount.  
Selecting “oFF” turns off the  
precount, so recording starts as  
soon as the L-17 (START/STOP)  
button or a keyboard key is  
pressed.  
oFF, 1*, 2  
E-101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
To edit an existing rhythm  
(1) Press the C-7 (MIXER) button to display the mixer  
screen.  
1. Perform steps 1 through 6 under “To rehearse  
before editing an existing rhythm” (page E-99).  
2. Perform the procedure under “To configure  
pattern rec settings (Rec Menu)” (page E-101).  
• This step is not necessary if you want to perform  
operations using initial default settings or if you want to  
use previous settings without changing them.  
3. Press the L-14 (NORMAL/FILL-IN) or L-15  
(VARIATION/FILL-IN) button to select the  
accompaniment pattern you want to edit.  
(2) Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to select one of the  
items described in the table below and then use the  
dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the setting.  
• You cannot edit the INTRO or ENDING  
Display:  
Item name  
Setting  
Range  
accompaniment pattern of an existing rhythm. If you  
want to create a new accompaniment pattern (INTRO,  
ENDING, etc.) from this point, see “To create a new  
accompaniment pattern” (page E-104) or “To create a  
new rhythm from scratch” (page E-106).  
Setting  
*1  
TONE:  
Part tone  
Specifies the instrument part  
tone.  
Part:  
Part On/Off  
Toggles an instrument between oFF, on  
sounding (on) and not sounding  
(oFF).*2  
4. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to select the  
instrument part you want to edit.  
Volume:  
Specifies the instrument part  
000 to 127  
Currently selected instrument part  
Part Volume volume.  
Pan:  
Part Pan  
Specifies whether the sound of –64 to 00 to  
the part can be heard from the  
left side or right side.  
+63*3  
Reverb:  
Specifies the level of reverb  
000 to 127  
Part Reverb (page E-33) applied to the  
Send  
instrument part.  
Chorus:  
Specifies the level of chorus  
000 to 127  
Part Chorus (page E-33) applied to the  
Send instrument part.  
*1 You can select any preset tone. Only drum set sounds  
(tone numbers K:129 through K:147) can be selected for  
drum parts and percussion parts. Drum set sounds  
cannot be selected for the bass and the Chord 1 through  
Chord 5 parts.  
*2 You can temporarily sound the notes of individual parts, if  
you want. For details, see step 5 under “To rehearse  
before editing an existing rhythm” (page E-99).  
*3 A smaller value shifts the pan position to the left while a  
larger value shifts to the right. A value of zero specifies  
center.  
Currently selected accompaniment pattern  
Currently selected instrument part status  
See “Instrument Part Editing and Rec Areas” (page E-97).  
5. Configure mixer settings for the selected  
instrument part. You can skip this step if you do  
not want to configure mixer settings.  
• Here you can press the L-17 (START/STOP) button to  
start playback of the accompaniment pattern and  
configure mixer settings as you monitor the effects of  
the settings on the notes being played.  
(3) To exit the mixer, press the C-7 (MIXER) button or the  
R-15 (EXIT) button.  
• This returns to the pattern sequencer screen.  
E-102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
6. If you want to record notes you play on the  
keyboard in real time, perform the following  
steps.  
(3) Checking the timing (beat and measure) of the  
playback of other parts, perform keyboard, PITCH  
BEND (S-1) wheel, and S-2 (MODULATION) button  
operations as required.  
• The operation you can perform here depends on the  
status (page E-98) of the currently selected part, as  
described below.  
• The operations you perform are recorded. What  
you record is played back when recording loops  
back to the measure and beat where you recorded  
a keyboard, pitch bend or modulation operation.  
• To delete specific recorded notes, hold down the  
C-10 (DELETE) button. When playback reaches  
the note you want to delete, press the keyboard  
that corresponds to the note to be deleted.  
Holding down the C-10 (DELETE) button along  
with one or more keyboard keys while playback is  
being performed will delete all of the notes that  
correspond to the keyboard keys as they played  
while the button and keys are held down.  
• Until you perform step (4) below, you can layer  
keyboard notes and delete recorded notes as many  
times as you like.  
For this status:  
You can perform this operation:  
Fix Data  
Perform step (2) of the procedure below  
to record new notes to replace the  
instrument parts in the rec areas.  
Recorded Data Perform step (2) of the procedure below  
to over-record additional notes while  
retaining note data previously recorded  
for instrument part.  
Empty  
Record all new notes (because the rec  
areas are empty).  
(1) Press the C-6 (RECORD) button.  
(4) To stop recording, press the C-6 (RECORD) button.  
• This stops accompaniment pattern playback and  
causes the button to go from lit to unlit. The  
instrument part status will become “Recorded  
Data”.  
• The button will start to flash and the Digital  
Keyboard will enter record standby.  
• You can press the C-6 (RECORD) button again  
here to exit record standby (button goes from lit to  
unlit).  
(2) To start recording while the C-6 (RECORD) button  
flashing, press the L-17 (START/STOP) button.  
• This causes the button to change from flashing to  
lit.  
7. If required, perform the procedure under “To  
edit events with the pattern sequencer” (page  
E-110).  
• You can make fine corrections to the notes you played  
on the keyboard and add new notes, if you want. For  
details, see “Editing Individual Events (Event Editor)”  
(page E-108).  
• If accompaniment pattern playback is stopped,  
accompaniment pattern repeat playback (excluding  
the instrument part being recorded) starts. Measure  
and beat values in the lower right corner of the  
display will count up along with playback until the  
end of the accompaniment pattern is reached.  
Then playback will restart from 001:1.  
E-103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
8. Repeat steps 4 through 7 for all of the parts you  
4. Configure the accompaniment pattern number  
want to edit.  
of measure and beat settings.  
(1) While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION) button,  
press the C-4 (EDIT) button to display the edit menu.  
• It is recommended that you save the rhythm as a user  
rhythm each time you finish editing each  
accompaniment pattern. For details about how to do  
this, see “To store an edited or newly created rhythm”  
(page E-106).  
9. Repeat steps 3 through 8 to edit all of the  
rhythm’s accompaniment patterns you want.  
10. After completing all of the editing you want,  
adjust the tempo of the rhythm as desired.  
• The tempo you set here becomes the initial default  
tempo of the accompaniment pattern.  
(2) Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“ElementEdit” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays the “ElementEdit” screen.  
(3) Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to select one of the  
items described in the table below and then use the  
dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the setting.  
11. For details about how to save the final version  
of the rhythm as a user rhythm, see “To store  
an edited or newly created rhythm” (page  
E-106).  
Display: Item name  
Setting Range  
To create a new accompaniment pattern  
Measure: Number of INTRO, ENDING: 01 to 16  
1. Press the C-4 (PATTERN SEQUENCER) button.  
measures  
Beat: Beat  
NORMAL, VARIATION: 01 to 16  
NORMAL FILL-IN, VARIATION  
FILL-IN: 01 to 02  
• This displays the pattern sequencer screen. For details  
about screen contents, see step 2 under “To rehearse  
before editing an existing rhythm” (page E-99).  
2/4 to 4/4 to 8/4, 2/8 to 16/8  
2. Perform the procedure under “To clear all  
instrument part rec areas included in an  
accompaniment pattern” (page E-115).  
(4) Press the R-15 (EXIT) button twice to exit the edit  
menu.  
5. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to select the  
• Select the accompaniment pattern you want to record  
anew and then perform the clear operation.  
instrument part you want to record.  
Currently selected instrument part  
3. Perform the procedure under “To configure  
pattern rec settings (Rec Menu)” (page E-101).  
• This step is not necessary if you want to perform  
operations using initial default settings or if you want to  
use previous settings without changing them.  
Currently selected accompaniment pattern  
Currently selected instrument part status (page E-97)  
E-104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
6. Configure mixer settings for the selected  
instrument part. You can skip this step if you do  
not want to configure mixer settings.  
(3) Checking the timing (beat and measure) of the  
playback, perform keyboard, PITCH BEND (S-1)  
wheel, and S-2 (MODULATION) button operations as  
required.  
• For details about mixer setting operations, see step 5  
under “To edit an existing rhythm” (page E-102).  
• The operations you perform are recorded. What  
you record is played back when recording loops  
back to the measure and beat where you recorded  
a keyboard, pitch bend or modulation operation.  
• To delete specific recorded notes, hold down the  
C-10 (DELETE) button. When playback reaches  
the note you want to delete, press the keyboard  
that corresponds to the note to be deleted.  
Holding down the C-10 (DELETE) button along  
with one or more keyboard keys while playback is  
being performed will delete all of the notes that  
correspond to the keyboard keys that are played  
while the button and keys are held down.  
• Until you perform step (4) below, you can layer  
keyboard notes and delete recorded notes as many  
times as you like.  
7. Configure part parameter settings for the  
selected instrument part. You can skip this step  
if you do not want to configure part parameter  
settings.  
• You also will be able to configure part parameter  
settings after recording, if you want. If you want to  
perform PITCH BEND (S-1) wheel operations while  
recording, it is a good idea to configure the bend range  
beforehand.  
• For details, see “Configuring Instrument Part Playback  
Settings (Part Parameters)” (page E-111).  
8. If you want to record notes you play on the  
(4) To stop recording, press the C-6 (RECORD) button.  
• This stops accompaniment pattern playback and  
causes the button to go from lit to unlit. The  
instrument part status will become “Recorded  
Data”.  
keyboard in real time, perform the following  
steps.  
(1) Press the C-6 (RECORD) button.  
• The button will start to flash and the Digital  
Keyboard will enter record standby.  
• You can press the C-6 (RECORD) button again  
here to exit record standby (button goes from lit to  
unlit).  
9. If required, perform the procedure under “To  
edit events with the pattern sequencer” (page  
E-110).  
(2) To start recording while the C-6 (RECORD) button  
flashing, press the L-17 (START/STOP) button.  
• The button will change from flashing to lit, and the  
display will show an up-count of measures and  
beats. The count will re-start from 001:1 when the  
final beat of the number of measures you specified  
in step 4 is reached.  
• You can make fine corrections to the notes you played  
on the keyboard and add new notes, if you want. For  
details, see “Editing Individual Events (Event Editor)”  
(page E-108).  
10. Repeat steps 5 through 9 for all of the parts you  
want to record.  
11. After completing all of the editing you want,  
adjust the tempo of the rhythm as desired.  
• The tempo you set here becomes the initial default  
tempo of the accompaniment pattern.  
12. For details about how to save the final version  
of the rhythm as a user rhythm, see “To store  
an edited or newly created rhythm” (page  
E-106).  
E-105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
2. The 0 should be next to “Store”, so press the  
To create a new rhythm from scratch  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
1. Press the C-4 (PATTERN SEQUENCER) button.  
• This displays a screen for specifying the destination  
user rhythm number and rhythm name.  
• This displays the pattern sequencer screen. For details  
about screen contents, see step 2 under “To rehearse  
before editing an existing rhythm” (page E-99).  
Destination user rhythm number  
2. Perform the procedure under “To clear all rec  
areas included in the currently selected  
rhythm” (page E-115).  
3. Perform the procedure under “To configure  
pattern rec settings (Rec Menu)” (page E-101).  
• This step is not necessary if you want to perform  
operations using initial default settings or if you want to  
use previous settings without changing them.  
Rhythm name  
4. Use buttons L-13 (INTRO) through L-16  
(SYNCHRO/ENDING) to select the  
accompaniment pattern you want to create  
anew.  
3. Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to select  
the destination user rhythm number you want.  
4. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the  
cursor to the name character position you want  
to change, and then use the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to select the character you want.  
5. Perform steps 4 and 10 under “To create a new  
accompaniment pattern”on page E-104.  
• For details about the characters you can input, see  
“Supported Input Characters” (page E-155).  
• To input a space, press both of the R-14 (–, +) buttons  
at the same time.  
6. Repeat steps 4 through 5 to create all of the  
accompaniment patterns you want.  
7. After completing all of the operations you want,  
adjust the tempo of the rhythm as desired.  
5. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• The tempo you set here becomes the initial default  
tempo of the accompaniment pattern.  
• This stores the data.  
• If the user rhythm number where you are storing the  
data already has data stored to it, a message  
(Replace?) will appear on the display to confirm  
whether you want to overwrite the existing data with the  
new data. Press the R-14 (YES) button to overwrite.  
8. For details about how to save the final version  
of the rhythm as a user rhythm, see “To store  
an edited or newly created rhythm” below.  
To store an edited or newly created rhythm  
• The message “Please Wait” will remain on the display  
while a data save operation is in progress. Do not  
perform any other operation while it is displayed.  
Turning off the Digital Keyboard or removing the  
memory card can cause Digital Keyboard data to be  
deleted or become corrupted. It also can cause the  
Digital Keyboard to fail to turn on when the L-1  
(POWER) button is pressed. If this happens, refer to  
“Troubleshooting” (page E-145).  
1. While the pattern sequencer screen is on the  
display after rhythm editing or creation is  
complete, hold down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button as you press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
• This displays the pattern sequencer menu screen.  
E-106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
Creating a User Rhythm by  
Combining Exiting Rhythm Parts  
(Easy Edit)  
You can combine instrument parts from different rhythms  
(preset or user) to create a new user rhythm. You also can  
use the mixer settings of each part to change the tone and  
adjust volume.  
• Pressing the R-15 (EXIT) button in place of the operation in  
step 1 displays the confirmation screen shown below.  
Pressing the R-14 (YES) button at this time will display the  
user rhythm store screen in step 2.  
To edit an existing rhythm with Easy Edit  
1. Select the rhythm you want to edit in order to  
create your user rhythm.  
To cancel the editor operation without saving the edited  
results, press the R-14 (NO) button.  
2. Press the C-4 (PATTERN SEQUENCER) button  
to display the pattern sequencer screen.  
To clear user rhythm data  
3. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-4 (EDIT) button to display  
the edit menu.  
1. Press the C-4 (PATTERN SEQUENCER) button  
to display the pattern sequencer screen.  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
• This displays the pattern sequencer menu screen.  
3. Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
“Clear” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays a screen for specifying the number of the  
rhythm you want to clear.  
4. The 0 should be next to “EasyEdit”, so press  
the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
4. Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to select  
• This displays the EASY EDIT screen shown below.  
the user rhythm number you want to clear.  
Instrument part being edited  
5. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
6. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to clear or  
the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
• The message “Please Wait” will remain on the display  
while a data save operation is in progress. Do not  
perform any other operation while it is displayed.  
Turning off the Digital Keyboard or removing the  
memory card can cause Digital Keyboard data to be  
deleted or become corrupted. It also can cause the  
Digital Keyboard to fail to turn on when the L-1  
(POWER) button is pressed. If this happens, refer to  
“Troubleshooting” (page E-145).  
Accompaniment pattern being edited  
Rhythm number and rhythm name assigned to the instrument part  
of the accompaniment pattern being edited (Default: Number and  
name selected in step 1)  
5. Use buttons L-13 (INTRO) through L-16  
(SYNCHRO/ENDING) to select the  
accompaniment pattern you want to edit.  
E-107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
6. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to select the  
Editing Individual Events  
(Event Editor)  
The pattern sequencer records the keyboard, pitch bender,  
and modulation operations recorded for each instrument part  
as “events”. Playing a note on the keyboard, for example,  
stores the following as events: note start measure, beat, and  
tick, note pitch, note length, and note intensity.  
The following editing operations are supported for individual  
events.  
instrument part you want to edit.  
7. Edit the selected accompaniment pattern  
instrument part as desired.  
• While performing the procedure below, you can press  
the L-17 (START/STOP) button and perform repeat  
playback of only the accompaniment pattern you are  
editing. Each press of the L-17 (START/STOP) button  
starts or stops playback.  
(1) While [RHYTHM] is displayed on the EASY EDIT  
screen, specify the number of the rhythm you want to  
assign to the instrument part of the selected  
accompaniment pattern.  
• Deleting events  
• Inserting events  
• Copying events within a specific range to a desired location  
• Quantizing* note events  
Settings are configured using the same procedures as  
those for rhythm selection. Perform steps 1, 2, and 3  
under “Playing an Auto Accompaniment” (page E-26).  
Specifying rhythm number F:101 at this time makes it  
possible to assign the rhythm data currently being  
edited with the pattern sequencer.  
• Deleting pitch bender events  
• Adjusting note event velocity values  
• Adjusting note event gate time values  
• Selecting the type of events that appear on the Event Editor  
screen (View Select)  
• Directly inputting note events (step input)  
(2) Configure the mixer settings of the selected  
accompaniment pattern instrument part as desired.  
• For details about mixer setting operations, see step  
5 under “To edit an existing rhythm” (page E-102).  
* Quantize is an operation that automatically adjusts the note  
on timing of a note event to match a reference note.  
• You can perform event editing on an instrument part  
whose status (page E-98) is “Recorded Data” or  
“Empty”. You cannot configure part parameters for an  
instrument part whose status is “Fix Data”.  
• Though you cannot perform event editing directly on  
an instrument part whose status is “Fix Data”, you can  
copy such an instrument part to a rec area and edit the  
copied data. For details about the copy operation, see  
“To copy preset or user rhythm instrument part data to  
a rec area” (page E-114).  
• Performing rhythm assignment in step (1) above also  
will automatically change mixer settings to the initial  
defaults for the assigned rhythm. Because of this,  
changing the rhythm after configuring mixer settings in  
step (2) will cause the configured mixer settings to be  
cleared.  
• When INTRO or ENDING is selected as the  
accompaniment pattern, the same rhythm is assigned  
to all eight instrument parts. Because of this,  
performing rhythm assignment in step (1) for an INTRO  
or ENDING will change the rhythm of all instrument  
parts at one time.  
8. Repeat steps 5 through 7 to edit other  
accompaniment patterns and instrument parts.  
9. After editing is complete, adjust the tempo of  
the rhythm as desired.  
• The tempo you set here becomes the initial default  
tempo.  
10. For details about how to save the final version  
of the rhythm as a user rhythm, see “To store  
an edited or newly created rhythm” (page  
E-106).  
E-108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
Pitch bender, modulation  
“Bend” (pitch bender even) or “Mod” (modulation event) is  
indicated to the right of the event location information,  
followed by parameter value. “VALU” is displayed at  
the cursor is located at a parameter value.  
Event Editor Screen Contents  
The event editor screen shows the individual events recorded  
to an instrument part as shown in the sample screen below.  
when  
1
Event being edited (selected event)  
1
Cursor  
Events before (previous event) and after  
(following event) the current event  
Event name (Bend or Mod)  
Parameter value (VALU)  
• The event editor screen shows three events at one time.  
The event in the middle line is the selected event. You can  
change the value where the solid-line cursor is located. A  
broken line under a setting value indicates that the cursor  
can be moved to that value.  
• The values in the format “001:01:00” at the beginning of the  
event indicate the recording location (timing) of the event as  
measure:beat:tick. A “tick” is a time unit that is shorter than  
one beat. Pattern sequencer data uses 96 ticks per beat  
(for 2/4 to 8/4) or 48 ticks per beat (for 2/8 to 16/8).  
Settings  
Event  
Parameters  
Note name  
Gate time  
Velocity  
Setting Range  
C- to C0 to G9*  
Note  
00:00 to 99:95  
001 to 127  
Pitch Bender Pitch Bender –8192 to 0000 to +8191  
Modulation Modulation 000 to 127  
Pattern sequencer records three types of events: notes  
(keyboard play), pitch bender operations, and modulation  
operations. These events are represented on the screen as  
described below.  
* When “C-” is displayed, it indicates C-1 (one octave below  
C0).  
Notes  
The note name is indicated to the right of the event location  
information, followed by the gate time (note length), and  
velocity (note speed) parameters.  
shows an abbreviation of  
1
the parameter name where the cursor is currently located.  
1
Note name (NOTE)  
Gate time (GATE)  
Velocity (VEL)  
B
E-109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
4. Perform the following operations.  
To edit events with the pattern sequencer  
Perform this procedure,  
starting from step 2:  
To do this:  
1. On the pattern sequencer screen, select the  
“Recorded Data” or “Empty” status instrument  
part whose events you want to edit.  
Change the settings of already “To edit an existing event”  
recorded event data  
(page E-87)  
• You can perform event editing on one of the following  
types of parts.  
– A “Recorded Data” or “Empty” status part that you  
are currently editing using the procedure under “To  
edit an existing rhythm” (page E-102)  
– A “Recorded Data” or “Empty” status part that you  
are currently editing using the procedure under “To  
create a new rhythm from scratch” (page E-106)  
– An “Empty” status part that has undergone one of  
the procedures under “To clear all rec areas  
included in the currently selected rhythm” (page  
E-115), “To clear a rec area of an instrument part”  
(page E-113), or “To clear all instrument part rec  
areas included in an accompaniment pattern” (page  
E-115)  
Delete an individual event  
“To delete an individual event”  
(page E-87)  
Delete all events in a track  
Delete all events within a  
specific range of the part being specific range of a track” (page  
edited  
“To delete all events in a track”  
(page E-88)  
“To delete all events in a  
E-88)  
Insert events  
“To insert an event” (page  
E-89)  
Copy events within a specific  
range to a desired location  
“To copy the events within a  
specific range to a desired  
location” (page E-89)  
Quantize an individual note  
event  
“To quantize an individual note  
event” (page E-90)  
– A “Recorded Data” status part that has undergone  
the procedure under “To copy preset or user rhythm  
instrument part data to a rec area” (page E-114)  
Quantize all note events in the “To quantize all note events in  
part being edited  
a track” (page E-91)  
Quantize all note events in a  
specific range of the part being within specific range of a track”  
edited  
“To quantize all note events  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-4 (EDIT) button to display  
the edit menu.  
(page E-91)  
Delete pitch bender events  
“Deleting Pitch Bender Events”  
(page E-92)  
Step input of note events  
“To perform step input” (page  
E-95)*1  
Batch adjust the velocity  
(intensity) of note events  
included in the part being  
edited  
“To adjust the velocity value of  
a note event” (page E-93)  
Batch adjust the gate time  
(length) of note events  
included in the part being  
edited  
“To adjust the gate time value  
of a note event” (page E-94)  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“EventEdit” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
Select the types of events that “To select the types of events  
appear on the event editor  
screen  
that appear on the Event Editor  
screen (View Select)” (page  
E-87)*2  
• This displays the event editor screen shown below. For  
information about display contents, see “Event Editor  
Screen Contents” (page E-109).  
*1 The “SysTrack” item on the input menu is not a pattern  
sequencer event editor item.  
*2 There are three view select setting items: Note,  
PitchBend, and Modulation.  
E-110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
4. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to select one of  
the items described in the table below and then  
use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting.  
Configuring Instrument Part  
Playback Settings  
(Part Parameters)  
The settings in this section control how instruments parts you  
are currently editing or creating are sounding when played  
back as Auto Accompaniment after being saved as a user  
rhythm. These settings are configured using the “PartPara”  
(Part Parameter) item on the edit menu.  
• For details about each setting item, see “Pattern  
Sequencer Part Parameters” on page E-112.  
• You can configure only bend range settings for drum  
and percussion parts.  
Display: Item name  
Table: Chord conversion table  
BreakPoint: Break Point  
Invert: Inversion  
Setting Range  
01 to 19  
C to B  
• You can configure part parameters for an instrument  
part whose status (page E-98) is “Recorded Data” or  
“Empty”. You cannot configure part parameters for an  
instrument part whose status is “Fix Data”.  
oFF, on, 7th  
oFF, on  
Retrigger: Retrigger  
BendRange: Bend Range  
00 to 12  
To configure pattern sequencer part  
parameters  
5. After configuring the settings you want, press  
the R-15 (EXIT) button twice.  
• This returns to the pattern sequencer screen.  
1. On the pattern sequencer screen, select the  
“Recorded Data” or “Empty” status instrument  
part whose part parameters you want to  
configure.  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-4 (EDIT) button to display  
the edit menu.  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“PartPara” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays the “Part Para” screen.  
E-111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
Pattern Sequencer Part Parameters  
Table (Chord conversion table)  
Recording of each accompaniment pattern is normally performed using C major (root of C, major type).* When playing an Auto  
Accompaniment, you can use a root other than C and a chord type other than major, if you want. This is accomplished by using a  
“chord conversion table” to convert the C major recorded data to another root and/or chord type. Regardless of what root or chord  
type you specify, the currently selected chord table is used to make corrections to suit the instrument parts and the type of music  
being played in order to ensure musically natural accompaniment.  
* Depending on the rec menu “PlayChord” setting. For details, see “To configure pattern rec settings (Rec Menu)” (page E-101).  
With this parameter, you can select from among the 19 types of chord conversion tables listed below.  
Accompaniment  
Number  
01  
Table Name  
Bass Basic  
Parts  
Bass  
Bass  
Bass  
Bass  
Description  
Normally used for a bass part.  
Pattern  
*1  
Variation of number 01. Always makes the first note the root  
note when changing chords.  
*1  
*1  
*1  
02  
Bass f-root  
Bass 7th  
03  
Used for a bass part recorded with a 7th chord.  
Variation of number 03. Always makes the first note the root  
note when changing chords.  
04  
Bass 7th f-root  
*1  
*1  
05  
06  
Chord Basic  
Chord Var2  
Chord  
Chord  
Normally used for a chord part.  
Used for a chord part that has a tension chord.  
When a 7th chord is specified while playing, the 5th note is  
converted to a 7th note. In the case of C7, for example, G  
becomes Bb.  
*1  
07  
Chord Var3  
Chord  
*1  
*1  
*1  
08  
09  
10  
Chord Var4  
Chord 7th  
Chord  
Chord  
Chord  
Variation of number 05 (Chord Basic).  
Used for a chord part recorded with a 7th chord.  
Used for a chord part recorded with a minor chord.  
Chord Minor  
Used for the chord part to which a phrase (such as a major  
scale) was recorded.  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*2  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
Phrase  
Chord  
Bass  
Chord Minor  
Chord Minor f-root  
Penta Phrase  
Intro n-minor  
Used for a bass part recorded with a minor chord.  
Variation of number 12. Always makes the first note the root  
note when changing chords.  
Bass  
Chord  
Used for a chord part recorded with a pentatonic scale phrase.  
When a minor chord is specified while playing, converts to a  
natural minor.  
Bass/chord  
When a minor chord is specified while playing, converts to a  
melodic minor (ascending).  
*2  
*2  
*2  
*2  
16  
17  
18  
19  
Intro m-minor  
Intro h-minor  
Intro no Change  
Intro dorian  
Bass/chord  
Bass/chord  
Bass/chord  
Bass/chord  
When a minor chord is specified while playing, converts to a  
harmonic minor.  
Recording of original as-is, with no minor/major conversion in  
accordance with chord specified while playing.  
When a minor chord is specified while playing, converts to a  
dorian scale.  
*1 For NORMAL, NORMAL FILL-IN, VARIATION, VARIATION FILL-IN  
*2 For INTRO and ENDING  
E-112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
BreakPoint (Break Point)  
Instrument Part Operations  
This parameter specifies the key, from C to B, that is the point  
at which Auto Accompaniment bass and chord notes drop one  
octave.  
For example when F is specified as the break point, a C major  
chord recorded as C3E3G3 (CEG) becomes D3F#3A3 (DF#A  
raised one note each) when D is fingered on the chord  
keyboard, E3G#3B3 (EG#B raised one note each) when E is  
fingered, and F2A2C3 (FAC dropped one octave) when F is  
fingered.  
To clear a rec area of an instrument part  
1. While the pattern sequencer screen is  
displayed, use buttons L-13 (INTRO) through  
L-16 (SYNCHRO/ENDING) to select the  
accompaniment pattern you want.  
• The rec areas of the instrument parts included in the  
accompaniment pattern you select here are the ones  
that can be cleared by this procedure.  
• If you select an INTRO or ENDING, the following steps  
can be performed only when all parts are in rec areas  
(“Recorded Data” or “Empty” part status).  
Invert (Inversion)  
This parameter specifies whether or not chords during Auto  
Accompaniment play should mirror inverted forms of the  
original chord (EGC and GCE for CEG).  
For example, let’s say that the original recorded C major  
chord is CEG and an F chord is fingered on the chord  
keyboard. If “oFF” is selected for this setting, the chord will be  
directly converted to FAC. If “on” (or “7th”) is selected, the  
chord will be converted to CFA, which is the inverted form that  
is nearest to CEG. The transition of chord notes during  
playback when “on” (or “7th”) is selected is smaller, so  
accompaniment sounds more natural.  
Note that you should select “7th” in place of “on” only if “C7”  
was specified for the “PlayChord” setting when recording the  
accompaniment pattern and if you selected “09 (Chord 7th)”  
for the chord conversion table.  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-4 (EDIT) button to display  
the edit menu.  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“PartEdit” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays the “Part Edit” screen.  
4. The 0 should be next to “Clear”, so press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
* “PlayChord” is a rec menu setting. For details, see “To  
configure pattern rec settings (Rec Menu)” (page E-101).  
• This displays the “Clear Part” screen.  
• When selecting “on” (or “7th”) for this setting, make sure  
that you select “C” for the “BreakPoint” (Break Point)  
setting.  
Retrigger (Retrigger)  
This parameter specifies how accompaniment pattern play is  
affected by a chord change that occurs part way through a  
pattern.  
When “on” is selected, the pattern “retriggers,” which causes  
the currently playing note to change to the corresponding note  
of the newly fingered chord. When “oFF” is selected, a chord  
change causes the currently sounding note to be cut off, and  
the next note of the pattern of the newly fingered chord to be  
played.  
5. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to specify the  
instrument part you want to clear from the rec  
area then press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
6. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to claer or  
the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
BendRange (Bend Range)  
This parameter specifies the bend range for pitch bender  
operation in semitone steps  
• Pressing the R-14 (YES) button changes the status of  
the instrument part you specified in step 5 to “Empty”.  
E-113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
5. Specify a rhythm number, accompaniment  
pattern, and instrument part as the copy  
destination.  
To copy preset or user rhythm instrument  
part data to a rec area  
• Use the R-17 (t, y, u, i) buttons to select one of  
the items described in the table below and then use the  
dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the setting.  
• This procedure copies note events only.  
• You will not be able to perform this procedure if an  
INTRO or ENDING is selected as the accompaniment  
pattern.  
• When a percussion part or drum part is specified as the  
copy destination instrument part, you can specify a  
percussion part or drum part as the copy source. When  
a bass part or a chord part (chord 1 through chord 5) is  
specified as the copy destination, you can specify a  
bass part or a chord part (chord 1 through chord 5) as  
the copy source. No other part combinations are  
allowed.  
Display: Item name  
Setting Range  
Copy source rhythm A:001 to F:100  
number  
1
Copy source  
accompaniment  
pattern  
normal (NORMAL),  
nrmFil (NORMAL FILL-IN),  
Variat (VARIATION),  
2
VarFil (VARIATION FILL-IN)  
Copy source part  
Percus (Percussion),  
Drum (Drums), Bass (Bass),  
Chord1 to Chord5 (Chord 1 to  
Chord 5)  
3
1. While the pattern sequencer screen is  
displayed, use the L-14 (NORMAL/FILL-IN) or  
L-15 (VARIATION/FILL-IN) button to select an  
accompaniment pattern, and the R-17 (u, i)  
buttons to select an instrument part.  
6. After the settings are the way you want, press  
the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
7. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to copy or  
the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
• The rec area of the accompaniment pattern/instrument  
part included in the accompaniment pattern is the copy  
destinations.  
• The copied instrument part status will become  
“Recorded Data”.  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-4 (EDIT) button to display  
the edit menu.  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“PartEdit” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays the “Part Edit” screen.  
4. Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
“Copy” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays the “Part Copy” screen.  
1
2
3
E-114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Pattern Sequencer  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“ElementEdit” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
Accompaniment Pattern and  
Rhythm Operations  
• This displays the “ElementEdit” screen.  
To clear all instrument part rec areas  
included in an accompaniment pattern  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to select one of  
the items described in the table below and then  
use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting.  
1. While the pattern sequencer screen is  
displayed, hold down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button and press the C-4 (EDIT) button to  
display the edit menu.  
Display: Item name  
Setting Range  
Measure:  
Number of measures  
INTRO, ENDING:01 to 16  
NORMAL, VARIATION:01 to 16  
NORMAL FILL-IN, VARIATION  
FILL-IN:01 to 02  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“ElementEdit” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
Beat: Beat  
2/4 to 4/4 to 8/4, 2/8 to 16/8  
• This displays the “ElementEdit” screen.  
4. After the settings are the way you want, press  
the R-15 (EXIT) button twice to return to the  
pattern sequencer screen.  
3. The 0 should be next to “Clear”, so press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This displays the “Clear Element” screen.  
To clear all rec areas included in the  
currently selected rhythm  
1. While the pattern sequencer screen is  
displayed, hold down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button and press the C-4 (EDIT) button to  
display the edit menu.  
2. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“AllEdit” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
4. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to specify the  
accompaniment pattern you want to clear and  
then press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This displays the “All Edit” screen.  
5. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to clear or  
the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
3. The 0 should be next to “Clear”, so press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
4. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to clear or  
the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
• Pressing the R-14 (YES) button changes the status of  
all the instrument parts of the accompaniment pattern  
you specified in step 4 to “Empty”.  
• Pressing the R-14 (YES) button changes the status of  
all the instrument parts of all the accompaniment  
patterns to “Empty”.  
To configure the accompaniment pattern  
number of measure and beat settings  
• This procedure can be performed only when the status  
of all of the instrument parts of the accompaniment  
pattern is “Empty”.  
1. While the pattern sequencer screen is  
displayed, hold down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button and press the C-4 (EDIT) button to  
display the edit menu.  
E-115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording and Playing Audio  
All of the sound output by the Digital Keyboard can be recorded as  
audio files on a memory card. The maximum recording time for a  
Audio Playback  
single audio file is approximately 13 minutes. You can have up to  
five audio files recorded on a single memory card.  
This Digital Keyboard supports playback of audio files recorded by  
it, as well as audio files that you converted on a computer to a  
format supported by the Digital Keyboard.* You also can play  
along on the keyboard during playback.  
* Special application software (Data Manager) is required in  
order to convert audio files. For details, see “Storing and  
Loading Digital Keyboard Memory Data” (page E-141).  
• To perform the operations described in this section, you  
will need to obtain a commercially available SD memory  
card or SDHC memory card with a capacity between 2GB  
and 32GB (page E-131).  
• The audio recording operation performs memory card  
delete and write operations simultaneously. Because of  
this, you may not be able to record correctly on certain  
types of memory cards. If you experience recording  
problems, try changing the file number of the recording or  
try using a different memory card.  
Saving Audio Files on a Computer  
You can use the special application software (Data Manager) to  
access audio files in Digital Keyboard memory from a computer.  
You can save audio files directly to the computer’s local disk and  
convert audio files to a format that is supported by the Digital  
Keyboard. For details, see “Storing and Loading Digital Keyboard  
Memory Data” (page E-141).  
Audio Recording and Playback  
Functions  
Audio Recording and Playback  
Precautions  
Audio Recording  
With audio recording, you can record sound output by the Digital  
Keyboard as digital sampling data. Recordings are stored on the  
memory card as an audio file.  
Limitations during Recording and Playback  
The following operations are not possible during audio recording  
and playback.  
• User rhythm editing (page E-98)  
• User tone editing (page E-45)  
• User DSP data editing (page E-35)  
• User preset editing (page E-53)  
• Song sequencer recording and editing (page E-63)  
• Registration setup save (page E-61)  
• Card mode operations (page E-132)  
Some other operations other than those listed above may also be  
disabled.  
Recording of Keyboard Play and Song Playback  
The following can be recorded as-is.  
• Rhythm mode keyboard play  
You can record a keyboard performance that uses layer and  
split, as well as Auto Accompaniment and music preset.  
Registration setup recall, effect operations, and mixer  
operations are also supported during recording.  
• Song sequencer song playback  
A song recorded with the song sequencer can be recorded to a  
memory card file as it is played back. Most Digital Keyboard  
operations that are supported during song playback are also  
supported during recording to a memory card file.  
Memory Card Precautions  
• Do not touch a memory card loaded in the Digital Keyboard  
while recording or playback is in progress. This can cause  
operational problems due to electrostatic charge and creates  
the risk of making the card unusable. Before touching the  
loaded memory card, first stop any ongoing recording or  
playback operation.  
Recording of Sound Input from an External Device  
Sound input from an external device connected to the Digital  
Keyboard’s T-8 (MIC IN) jack or T-5 (INST IN) jack is recorded  
along with notes played on the Digital Keyboard and sound that is  
played back on the Digital Keyboard.  
• Formatting a memory card on the Digital Keyboard will reserve  
space for audio recording, which will reduce the total capacity  
of the memory card by approximately 640MB. Using a  
computer to open a memory card that has been formatted on  
the Digital Keyboard will show this reduced capacity, even if  
there are no files on the card. This is normal and does not  
indicate malfunction of the memory card.  
For details about the routes used for output of sound from this  
Digital Keyboard’s built-in sound source and output of sound from  
an external sound source, see the block diagram under  
“Configuration of Effects” (page E-31).  
• Input from the Digital Keyboard’s T-6 (AUDIO IN) jack is not  
recorded.  
E-116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording and Playing Audio  
Performing Audio Recording  
Modes that Support Audio Recording  
You can record keyboard play while in the rhythm mode or song sequencer mode.  
• Recording is actually performed in the audio record mode, but you can switch between the rhythm mode screen and song  
sequencer mode screen from the audio record mode screen. A : or < indicator on the display indicates whether  
the rhythm mode screen or song sequencer mode screen is selected.  
Audio record mode  
Rhythm mode  
song sequencer mode  
Audio record screen  
Audio record screen  
C-5 (SONG  
SEQUENCER) button  
R-17 (t, y)  
buttons  
R-17 (t, y)  
buttons  
Rhythm mode screen  
song sequencer mode screen  
C-9 (CARD) button  
• Normally the audio record screen is displayed in the audio record mode, but you can switch to the rhythm mode screen or song  
sequencer mode screen temporarily when you need to perform operations there. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to switch  
between the audio record screen and the rhythm mode screen or sequencer mode screen.  
• You can use the C-9 (CARD) and C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER) buttons to switch between the rhythm mode screen and song  
sequencer mode screen while in the audio record mode.  
For details about navigating between modes and how to switch between screens, see “Navigating between Modes and Screens  
during Recording Standby and Recording” (page E-120).  
E-117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording and Playing Audio  
C-2 C-3 C-5  
C-9  
R-13  
R-14  
R-15  
R-16  
R-17  
L-13  
L-14 L-16 L-18  
L-15 L-17  
C-17  
To get ready for audio recording  
To record play in the rhythm mode  
1. Referring to “Audio Recording” (page E-116),  
determine what type of performance you want  
to record.  
1. Perform the procedure under “To get ready for  
audio recording” (page E-118).  
• This enters the rhythm mode.  
2. Select a tone and rhythm, and configure other  
2. If you plan to use a microphone, CD player or  
some other external device as a sound source  
during recording, turn off both the external  
device and the Digital Keyboard and then  
connect them.  
settings for the song you plan to record.  
3. Press the C-3 (AUDIO RECORD) button.  
• For details about connections, see “Outputting Input  
from an External Device or a Microphone through the  
Digital Keyboard’s Speakers” (page E-12).  
3. Turn on the keyboard.  
• This cause the > indicator to flash, which indicates  
the audio record mode.  
• The C-3 (AUDIO RECORD) button will also start  
flashing, which indicates audio record standby.  
• The audio record screen like the one shown below will  
appear on the display.  
4. On the Digital Keyboard, format a memory card.  
• For details, see “Formatting a Memory Card” (page  
E-132).  
5. Press the R-15 (EXIT) button to return to the  
rhythm mode from the card mode.  
Audio file number  
• If you have a memory card that you previous formatted  
on the Digital Keyboard, skip steps 4 and 5, and simply  
insert the card into the card slot (T-1). For details, see  
“Loading and Removing a Memory Card” (page E-132).  
This completes preparation for recording. Next, perform the  
“To record play in the rhythm mode” below or the “To record  
play in the song sequencer mode” procedure (page E-120).  
Audio file name  
Time counter (minutes:seconds)  
• The time counter shows how much time  
(minutes:seconds) has elapsed since the start of  
recording. You also can switch display contents to  
show the tempo, measure, and beat, if you want as  
described below.  
• If there is an asterisk (*) in front of the audio file  
number, it means the file already includes recorded  
data. Starting recording while a file that already  
contains recorded data is selected will cause the old  
data to be overwritten by the new recording.  
E-118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording and Playing Audio  
• If you selected a file number with an asterisk (*) in front  
of it in step 5, a file overwrite confirmation screen like  
the one shown below will appear.  
4. If required, perform the steps below to switch  
from the time counter screen to the tempo,  
measure, beat screen. If you want to leave the  
time counter displayed, go straight to step 5.  
(1) While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION) button,  
press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
This displays a screen like the one shown below.  
If you do not want to overwrite the file, press the R-14  
(NO) button. This will return to step 5 of this procedure  
where you can select a different audio file number.  
If you do want to overwrite the file, press the R-14 (YES)  
button. Recording will start and the C-3 (AUDIO  
RECORD) button will change from flashing to lit. Start to  
play what you want.  
(2) Use the R-17 (y) button to move the thick brackets  
(%) to “Measure Beat” and then press the R-15  
(EXIT) button.  
7. To quit recording, press the C-3 (AUDIO  
This switches from the time counter to the tempo,  
measure, beat screen.  
RECORD) button again.  
• This will cause the button to change from lit to unlit and  
end recording.  
• The > indicator will stop flashing on the display to  
indicate the audio play mode.  
To return to the time counter screen, the R-17 (t)  
button in step (2) to move the thick brackets (%) to  
“Recording Time” and then press the R-15 (EXIT)  
button.  
• Pressing the L-17 (PLAY/STOP) button here will stop  
recording and start playback of the audio file. For  
details about audio file playback, see “Playing Back  
Audio” (page E-121).  
5. Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to select  
an audio file number.  
6. To start recording, press the C-3 (AUDIO  
• To exit the audio play mode, press the C-2 (AUDIO  
PLAY) button.  
RECORD) button.  
• If the file number you selected in step 5 does not have  
an asterisk (*) next to it, the C-3 (AUDIO RECORD)  
button will change from flashing to lit and recording will  
start. Start to play what you want.  
• During audio record standby, you can exit the audio record  
mode by pressing the R-15 (EXIT) button.  
• If you switch from the time counter to tempo, measure, beat  
in step 4 of the procedure above, the count up operation will  
begin when song (when in the song sequencer mode) or  
rhythm (when in the rhythm mode) playback is started.  
• The time counter (or tempo, measure, beat display) will  
start to flash when there are 30 seconds of remaining  
recording time. Recording will stop automatically when the  
end of remaining recording time is reached.  
Flashing (Record standby)  
Lit (Recording)  
E-119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording and Playing Audio  
To record play using a music preset  
Navigating between Modes and Screens  
during Recording Standby and Recording  
1. Perform the procedure under “To get ready for  
audio recording” (page E-118).  
You can use the operations in this section to navigate  
between modes and screens while recording.  
• This enters the rhythm mode.  
Rhythm Mode Operations (: indicator  
displayed)  
2. Perform steps 1 through 4 under “To perform  
using a music preset” (page E-49).  
Operations in the Rhythm Mode  
• This enters music preset record standby.  
• You can use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to switch between  
the audio record screen and the rhythm mode screen.  
• While the audio record screen is displayed, press the C-9  
(CARD) button to display the rhythm mode screen.  
3. Perform steps 3 through 6 under “To record  
play in the rhythm mode” (page E-118) to start  
recording.  
Displaying the Song Sequencer Mode Screen from the  
Rhythm Mode Screen  
4. Perform steps 5 through 7 under “To perform  
• While the audio record screen or rhythm mode screen is  
displayed, press the C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER) button to  
display the song sequencer mode screen. This will cause  
the : indicator to disappear from the display and the  
< indicator to appear.  
using a music preset” (page E-49).  
5. To quit recording, press the C-3 (AUDIO  
RECORD) button.  
To record play in the song sequencer mode  
Song Sequencer Mode Operations (<  
indicator displayed)  
1. Perform the procedure under “To get ready for  
audio recording” (page E-118).  
Operations in the Song Sequencer Mode  
• You can use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to switch between  
the audio record screen and the song sequencer mode  
screen.  
• While the song sequencer mode screen is displayed, press  
the C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER) button to display the audio  
record screen.  
• This enters the rhythm mode.  
2. Perform steps 1 through 3 under “To play a  
recorded song” (page E-74) to prepare for song  
playback.  
• This enters the song sequencer mode.  
Displaying the Rhthm Mode Screen from the Song  
Sequencer Mode Screen  
3. Perform steps 3 through 6 under “To record  
play in the rhythm mode” (page E-118) to start  
recording.  
• While the audio record screen or song sequencer mode  
screen is displayed, press the C-9 (CARD) button to display  
the rhythm mode screen. This will cause the <  
indicator to disappear from the display and the :  
indicator to appear.  
• While the audio record screen or rhythm mode screen is  
displayed, press the C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER) button to  
display the rhythm mode screen. This will cause the  
< indicator to disappear from the display and the  
: indicator to appear. The screen content does not  
change at this time.  
4. Press the L-17 (START/STOP) button to start  
song playback.  
5. To quit recording, press the C-3 (AUDIO  
RECORD) button.  
E-120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording and Playing Audio  
• The audio playback screen shown below will be on the  
display.  
Playing Back Audio  
Audio file number  
• You can start audio playback operations from the rhythm  
mode or the song sequencer mode. You cannot start from  
the card mode.  
• You can perform normal keyboard play along with audio  
playback, and you can use layer and split. The procedures  
for selecting UPPER 1, UPPER 2, and LOWER parts are  
the same as the ones used in the rhythm mode. For details,  
see “Selecting a Tone” (page E-14) and “Layering and  
Splitting Tones” (page E-15).  
Audio file name  
Time counter (minutes:seconds)  
• Maximum polyphony is reduced by a maximum of two  
notes during audio playback.  
• Rhythm play and song sequencer song playback cannot be  
performed during audio playback standby and audio  
playback.  
• If there is an asterisk (*) in front of the audio file  
number, it means the file already includes recorded  
data.  
• The time counter displayed during audio playback does not  
exactly match the time counter displayed during recording.  
2. Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to select  
one the audio file numbers that has an asterisk  
(*) in front of it.  
Supported Audio Playback Files  
3. Configure the following setting as required.  
This Digital Keyboard supports playback of audio files  
recorded by it, as well as audio files that you converted on a  
computer to a format supported by the Digital Keyboard.*  
* Special application software (Data Manager) is required in  
order to convert audio files. For details, see “Storing and  
Loading Digital Keyboard Memory Data” (page E-141).  
To do this:  
Start playback from Use the L-15 (dFF) and L-14  
any location (sREW) buttons to change the time  
Do this:  
(minutes : seconds) counter reading to the location from  
which you want to start playback.  
Center cancel*  
Press the L-18 (PART SELECT)  
button.  
To play back a recorded audio file  
1. Press the C-2 (AUDIO PLAY) button.  
* For details, see “About center cancel” on page E-122.  
• This causes the > indicator to appear and the other  
mode indicator (: or <) to disappear  
from the display, which indicates the audio play mode.  
• The L-17 (PLAY/STOP) button will flash, which  
indicates audio playback standby.  
E-121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording and Playing Audio  
4. Press the L-17 (PLAY/STOP) button.  
About center cancel  
• This will start playback of the audio file and cause the  
L-17 (PLAY/STOP) button to change from flashing to  
lit. The time counter also will start counting up.  
• The following operations are supported during  
playback.  
Center cancel can be used to cut out the vocal part (which is  
normally located in the center of the stereo field) from an  
audio file stored to a memory card from your computer. How  
successful center cancel is in cutting out the audio depends  
on the audio file you are playing back.  
Each press of the L-18 (PART SELECT) button toggles  
between center cancel and normal (no center cancel)  
playback. The current setting can be determined by checking  
the graphic formed inside the level indicator as shown below.  
To perform this  
Do this:  
operation:  
Fast forward  
Fast backward  
Pause  
Hold down the L-15 (dFF) button or  
rotate the dial to the right.*  
Playback in  
Status  
Playback standby  
Hold down the L-14 (sREW) button  
progress  
or rotate the dial to the left.*  
Press the L-16 (PAUSE) button.  
Press the L-16 (PAUSE) button.  
Restart paused  
playback  
Lower playback  
volume  
Press the R-14 (–) button, which will  
display a volume setting screen.  
Rotating the dial to the left while this  
screen is displayed also will lower  
playback volume.  
Normal  
Raise playback  
volume  
Press the R-14 (+) button, which will  
display a volume setting screen.  
Rotating the dial to the right while this  
screen is displayed also will raise  
playback volume.  
Center cancel  
Press the L-18 (PART SELECT)  
button.  
Center cancel  
* Dial operation is supported only while the audio play screen  
is displayed.  
• Playback stops automatically when it reaches the end  
of a song. To stop playback part way through, press the  
L-17 (PLAY/STOP) button.  
5. To exit the audio play mode, press the C-2  
• When the MIC/INST parameter (page E-42) “Pan” setting is  
“0” (initial default value), center cancel is applied to all  
sound recorded from an external device connected to the  
T-8 (MIC IN) jack or the T-5 (INST IN) jack.  
(AUDIO PLAY) button.  
• This returns to the mode screen (rhythm mode or song  
sequencer mode) that was displayed before you  
performed step 1 of this procedure.  
• During audio record standby, you can exit the audio play  
mode by pressing the R-15 (EXIT) button.  
• During the above operation, you can press the C-2 (AUDIO  
PLAY) button to exit the audio play mode.  
E-122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording and Playing Audio  
To rename an audio file  
To repeat play a specific phrase  
1. Perform steps 1 through 4 under “To play back  
a recorded audio file” (page E-121) to start  
playback.  
1. Press the C-2 (AUDIO PLAY) button to enter the  
audio play mode.  
2. Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to display  
the audio file number of the file you want to  
rename.  
2. When playback reaches the location you want  
to specify as the repeat start point, press the  
L-13 (REPEAT) button.  
3. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) to display the  
audio play menu.  
• This will display a screen like the one shown below,  
which shows the start point you specified  
(minutes:seconds) and the flashing ? indicator.  
3. When playback reaches the location you want  
to specify as the repeat end point, press the  
L-13 (REPEAT) button again.  
4. The 0 should be next to “Rename”, so press  
the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This displays the “Rename” screen.  
• This will immediately return to the start point you  
specified in step 2 and start repeat playback. At this  
time a screen like the one shown below showing the  
end point you specified (minutes:seconds) will be  
displayed first. After a few seconds, the display will  
change to the original audio play screen.  
5. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the  
cursor to the name character position you want  
to change, and then use the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to select the character you want.  
• For details about the characters you can input, see  
“Supported Input Characters” (page E-155).  
• To input a space, press both of the R-14 (–, +) buttons  
at the same time.  
6. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
7. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to change  
the name or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel and  
return to the audio play screen.  
• The ? indicator will be on the display while repeat  
playback is in progress.  
• The operations you can perform during repeat playback  
are the same as those that are supported during normal  
playback. For details, see step 4 under “To play back a  
recorded audio file” (page E-121).  
• Pressing the R-15 (EXIT) button without pressing the  
R-14 button will return to the screen in step 5 of this  
procedure.  
4. To cancel repeat playback, first press the L-17  
(PLAY/STOP) button to stop it. Next, press the  
L-13 (REPEAT) button.  
• This causes the ? indicator to disappear from the  
display.  
E-123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recording and Playing Audio  
To clear the data of an audio file or delete an  
audio file  
1. Press the C-2 (AUDIO PLAY) button to enter the  
audio play mode.  
2. Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to display  
the audio file you want to clear or delete.  
• Selecting an audio file numbered from 001 through 005  
will make this an audio file data clear operation. In this  
case, the file itself will not be deleted.  
• Selecting an audio file numbered 006 or greater (an  
audio file you saved to the memory card using Data  
Manager* on a computer) will make this an audio file  
delete operation.  
* For details, see “Storing and Loading Digital  
Keyboard Memory Data” (page E-141).  
3. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button to display  
the audio play menu.  
4. Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
“Clear” (or “Delete”) and then press the R-16  
(ENTER) button.  
5. In response to the confirmation message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to perform  
the applicable operation or the R-14 (NO) button  
to cancel.  
E-124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Function Menu  
R-13  
R-14  
R-15  
R-16  
R-17  
C-17  
R-18  
The function menu contains items for tuning and touch  
3. The setting items from “Performance” and  
below are groups that include multiple setting  
items. Use the following procedure to change  
adjustments, local on/off, and other global settings that need  
to be changed by you relatively infrequently. It also includes  
some memory card operations (format, etc.).  
the settings of the items in each group.  
(1) Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to the  
desired group name and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
Using the Function Menu  
This section explains function menu operations. For details  
about specific function menu items, see “Function Menu  
Settings” (page E-126).  
• This displays the items included within the group.  
To change the setting of a function menu  
item  
1. Press the R-13 (FUNCTION) button.  
Example: Performance group  
(2) Use the R-17 (t, y, u, i) buttons to move the 0  
to the setting you want to change.  
(3) Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
setting value.  
• Pressing the R-14 (–, +) buttons at the same time  
returns an item to its initial default setting.  
(4) To return to the function menu, press the R-15 (EXIT)  
button.  
• This displays the function menu like the one shown  
below.  
2. To adjust the “Tune” (Tuning) setting, use the  
dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
value inside the thick brackets (%).  
• Pressing the R-14 (–, +) buttons at the same time  
returns the setting to its initial default.  
• Changing the tuning value does not affect audio  
playback (page E-121).  
E-125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Function Menu  
4. To exit the function menu, press the R-13  
Touch (Touch Response)  
(FUNCTION) button or R-15 (EXIT) button.  
Select one of the settings below to specify the relationship  
between key pressure and note volume.  
oFF : Constant note volume regardless of keyboard pressure  
1* : Normal  
• Note that all function menu settings you configure are  
returned to their initial defaults whenever you turn off  
the Digital Keyboard. You can configure the Digital  
Keyboard so it remembers its latest settings or to apply  
predetermined default settings each time you turn it on.  
For details, see “AutoResume (Auto Resume)” (page  
E-129) and “Default (Default Settings)” (page E-129).  
• Some function menu settings also can be saved to  
registration memory. For details, see “Saving  
2
: Strong sound even with light pressure  
TchOffVel (Touch Off Velocity)  
Specifies the velocity value setting when the Touch setting is  
off.  
000 - 100* - 127  
Keyboard Setups to Registration Memory” (page E-61).  
Ped.Assign (Pedal Assign)  
Specifies the operation of the pedal connected to T-3  
(SUSTAIN/ASSIGNABLE JACK).  
SUS*: Sustain pedal  
SSt : Sostenuto pedal  
SFt : Soft pedal  
Function Menu Settings  
This section explains the meaning of each function menu  
setting item, and provides information about setting ranges  
and initial default values.  
• For each item, the initial default setting is indicated by an  
asterisk (*).  
rHy : Start/stop switch  
BendRange (Bend Range)  
Specifies the range of pitch change that occurs when the  
PITCH BEND wheel (S-1) is rotated.  
00 - 02* - 24 semitones  
Tune (Tuning)  
Fine tunes the overall keyboar tuning in 0.1 Hz steps.  
A4=415.5 - 440.0* - 465.9Hz  
ArpegHold (Arpeggiator Hold)  
Specifies the how arpeggio is played in accordance with  
pressed keyboard keys when the arpeggiator (page E-21) is  
being used.  
• Changing the tuning value does not affect audio playback  
(page E-121).  
oFF* : Arpeggio played while the keys of a chord are  
depressed on the keyboard  
Performance (Performance/Accompaniment)  
Group  
on : Arpeggio played after keyboard keys are released  
• When “on” is selected for this setting, you can turn off  
arpeggio play pressing the R-18 (AUTO HARMONIZE/  
ARPEGGIATOR) button to disable the arpeggiator, or you  
can change this setting to “oFF”.  
• You can directly display this group screen without going  
through the function menu. While the initial power on  
screen is displayed, hold down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button as you press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
E-126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Function Menu  
Play/CardUtl (Playback, Card Utility) Group  
ArpegSpeed (Arpeggiator Speed)  
Specifies how many times notes or chords should sound  
within one beat for arpeggio phrases played by the  
arpeggiator (page E-21).  
• You can directly display this group screen without going  
through the function menu. While in the card mode (page  
E-132), hold down the R-13 (FUNCTION) button as you  
press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
1, 2, 2S, 3, 4*, 4S, 6, 8  
The setting value indicates the number of times within one  
beat. Selecting an option that is only a value will sound the  
note that number of times within one beat. Selecting “4”, for  
example, will play with the rhythm 7777.  
Selecting an option that includes the letter “S” will play a  
2 6  
6767  
shuffle. 2S plays  
and 4S plays  
.
• The availability of the settings for this item depends on the  
arpeggiator type. Refer to the separate “Appendix” for  
details.  
PreCount (Song Pre-count Sound)  
ArpegPart (Arpeggiator Part)  
Specifies if a pre-count should sound (on) when playback of a  
song file is started in the card mode (page E-132) or if a  
pre-count should not sound (oFF*).  
Specifies whether arpeggiator play should be used for the  
UPPER part keyboard or LOWER part keyboard when the  
arpeggiator (page E-21) is used while the keyboard is split  
between two tones (page E-15).  
Upp* : UPPER part  
SongRepeat (Song Repeat Play)  
Low : LOWER part  
Specifies if a single song file should be repeat played (on)  
during playback in the card mode (page E-132) or if a song file  
should not be repeat played (oFF*).  
RegFltAcmp (Registration Filter: Accompaniment)  
Specifies if accompaniment settings are recalled (oFF*) when  
a registration setup (page E-61) is recalled, or if  
accompaniment settings are not recalled (on).  
AllData (All Data)  
You can batch save all user data in Digital Keyboard memory  
to a memory card, or load all user data from a memory card to  
Digital Keyboard memory.  
RegFltScal (Registration Filter: Scale)  
See “To batch save all Digital Keyboard data to a memory  
card” (page E-134) and “To batch load all Digital Keyboard  
memory data from a memory card” (page E-135) for more  
information.  
Specifies if scale settings are recalled (oFF) when a  
registration setup (page E-61) is recalled, or if scale settings  
are not recalled (on*).  
CardFormat (Card Format)  
See “Formatting a Memory Card” (page E-132).  
FileDelete (File Delete)  
See “To delete a file from a memory card” (page E-136).  
FileRename (File Rename)  
See “To rename a file on a memory card” (page E-136).  
E-127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Function Menu  
Volume (Volume) Group  
MIDI Group  
KeyboardCh (Keyboard Channel)  
• For details about “parts” mentioned here, see “How Parts  
are Organized” (page E-38).  
Selects the channel for sending keyboard play MIDI data to an  
external device (keyboard channel).  
01* - 16  
AccompVol. (Auto Accompaniment Volume)  
LocalCtrl (Local Control)  
Adjusts the Auto Accompaniment volume level (master  
volume of parts A09 through A16). This setting does not affect  
the keyboard volume level (parts A01 through A03).  
000 - 115* - 127  
Specifies whether pressing a key sounds the internal sound  
source (on*) or whether the keyboard and internal sound  
source should be disconnected (oFF).  
SongVol. (Song Volume)  
AccompOut (Accompaniment MIDI Out)  
Adjusts the master volume of song file playback in the card  
mode (page E-132). This setting does not affect the keyboard  
volume level (parts A01 through A03) or Auto Accompaniment  
volume level (parts A09 through A16).  
Specifies if Auto Accompaniment MIDI data should be sent to  
an external device (on) or not sent to an external device  
(oFF*).  
000 - 127*  
General (Other) Group  
MetroVol. (Metronome Volume)  
Adjusts the metronome volume. This setting is linked with the  
A08 part volume (part volume) that can be adjusted with the  
mixer (page E-38).  
000 - 100* - 127  
AudioVol. (Audio Volume)  
Adjusts volume when playing back an audio file with audio  
playback (page E-116).  
000 - 127*  
Speaker (Speaker ON/OFF)  
Turns speaker output on or off.  
Select “on*” to enable output from the Digital Keyboard’s  
speakers or “oFF” to disable speaker output. Output continues  
to be performed from the T-4 (PHONES) and T-9 (LINE OUT)  
jacks even when “oFF” is selected for this setting.  
A pointer indicator is displayed next to SPEAKER OFF when  
“oFF” is selected for this item.  
Contrast (LCD Contrast)  
Adjusts display contrast.  
01 - 09* - 17  
B
E-128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Function Menu  
4. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to select the  
AutoPower (Auto Power Off)  
operation you want.  
Specifies if Auto Power Off (page E-13) is enabled (on*) or  
disabled (oFF). Even when “on” is selected for this setting,  
you can temporarily disable Auto Power Off by holding down  
the L-4 ([A] POPS/ROCK/DANCE) button as you press the  
L-1 (POWER) button to turn on power.  
To do this:  
Move the 0 here:  
Return the power on default settings  
to the factory default settings (clearing  
default settings).  
Clear  
Rewrite the power on default settings Store  
with the Digital Keyboard’s current  
setup (registering default settings).  
AutoResume (Auto Resume)  
Specifies whether the Digital Keyboard should remember its  
setup when turned off and restore it the next time it is turned  
on.  
• For information about the setting items that are  
registered as default settings, see “Parameter List”  
(page E-158).  
oFF* : Restores power on defaults when power is turned on.  
on : Remembers setup when power is turned off and  
restores it when power is turned back on.  
5. After everything is the way you want, press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• The message “Complete” appears and the display  
returns to the screen before you pressed the R-16  
(ENTER) button in step 3.  
• For information about the setting items that are restored  
when Auto Resume is enabled, see “Parameter List” (page  
E-158).  
• Initially, power on default settings are the same as the  
factory default settings. You also can use the procedure  
below to specify other power on default settings to suit your  
needs.  
6. To exit the function menu, press the R-13  
(FUNCTION) button.  
• If you want the default settings to be restored whenever  
power is turned on, select “oFF” for the “AutoResume”  
setting (page E-129).  
Default (Default Settings)  
You can use this setting item to do the following.  
• Rewrite the power on default settings with the Digital  
Keyboard’s current setup (registering default settings).  
• Return the power on default settings to the factory default  
settings (clearing default settings).  
Initialize (Initialize)  
This item can be used to initialize all data and settings, or  
parameter settings only.  
To register or clear default settings  
1. Press the R-13 (FUNCTION) button to display  
• For information about what settings are initialized when  
“Parameter” is selected for initialization in step 4 of the  
procedure below, see “Parameter List” (page E-158).  
the function menu.  
2. Use the R-17 (i, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“General” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“Default” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays the default setting screen like the one  
shown below.  
E-129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Function Menu  
To initialize all data and settings (or parameter  
settings only)  
1. Press the R-13 (FUNCTION) button to display  
the function menu.  
2. Use the R-17 (i, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“General” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
3. Use the R-17 (i, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“Initialize” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays the initialize screen like the one shown  
below.  
4. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to select either  
“All” (all settings) or “Parameter” (parameter  
settings only).  
5. To execute initialization, press the R-16  
(ENTER) button.  
E-130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using a Memory Card  
C-9  
R-13  
R-14  
R-16  
R-17  
You can save Digital Keyboard user area data to a memory  
card and load data from a memory card to Digital Keyboard  
memory. You also can play music files (MIDI files) stored on a  
memory card on the Digital Keyboard.  
• For information about saving and importing individual data  
items, see “Saving Digital Keyboard Data to a Memory  
Card” (page E-133) and “Loading Data from a Memory  
Card” (page E-135).  
• For details about saving and loading all data, see “To batch  
save all Digital Keyboard data to a memory card” (page  
E-134) and “To batch load all Digital Keyboard memory  
data from a memory card” (page E-135).  
• Use a memory card that satisfies the conditions below.  
Format: SDHC or SD  
Capacity: 2GB to 32GB  
Use of any memory cards other than those defined  
above is not supported.  
Data that can be directly played back from a  
memory card  
Description  
Data Type  
(File Name Extension)  
Supported Data Types  
Song files  
SMF format 0 or 1 MIDI files (MID)  
(page E-137)  
Data that can be saved to and exported from a  
memory card  
Description  
Data Type  
• If you want to use SMF or rhythm data on a memory card  
that is not supported by this Digital Keyboard (such as an  
SD memory card with capacity less than 2GB), you need  
either to copy the data to a supported memory card on the  
Digital Keyboard, or use Data Manager to transfer the data  
from a computer to the Digital Keyboard. For more  
information, see “Importing Data from Various Storage  
Media” (page E-142).  
(File Name Extension)  
User rhythm data  
(page E-98)  
Auto Accompaniment data edited  
with this Digital Keyboard (AC7)  
User tone data  
(page E-44)  
Tone data edited with this Digital  
Keyboard (TN7)  
User DSP data  
(page E-35)  
DSP data edited with this Digital  
Keyboard (DS7)  
User preset data  
(page E-53)  
Music preset data edited on this  
Digital Keyboard (MPS)  
Card and Card Slot Precautions  
Song sequencer data  
(page E-63)  
Song data edited with this Digital  
Keyboard (CMS, MID*)  
• Be sure to observe the precautions provided in the  
documentation that comes with the memory card.  
• Memory cards have a write-protect switch. Use it when you  
want to protect the data on the card from accidental  
deletion.  
Registration data  
(page E-61)  
This Digital Keyboard’s panel  
settings (RM7)  
Scale memory data  
(page E-25)  
Scale setting data recorded by the  
Digital Keyboard (SCD)  
• Avoid using a memory card under the following conditions.  
Such conditions can corrupt data stored on the memory  
card.  
All data  
All the above data (AL7)  
* Save only.  
– Areas subjected to high temperature, high humidity, or  
corrosive gas.  
– Areas subjected to strong electrostatic charge and digital  
noise.  
• Never touch the contacts of a memory card when loading it  
or removing it from the Digital Keyboard.  
E-131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using a Memory Card  
• The message “Please Wait” will remain on the display while  
a data save operation is in progress. Do not perform any  
other operation while it is displayed.  
Entering the Card Mode  
Enter the card mode when you want to perform memory card  
Turning off the Digital Keyboard or removing the memory  
card can cause Digital Keyboard data to be deleted or  
become corrupted. It also can cause the Digital Keyboard  
to fail to turn on when the L-1 (POWER) button is pressed.  
If this happens, refer to “Troubleshooting” (page E-145).  
• Never insert anything besides a memory card into the card  
slot. Doing so creates the risk of malfunction.  
operations.  
• While in the rhythm mode (page E-7) press the C-9 (CARD)  
button to enter the card mode.  
• Electrostatic charge from your fingers or the memory card  
to the card slot can cause malfunction of the Digital  
Keyboard. If this happens, turn the Digital Keyboard off and  
then back on again.  
• A memory card can become quite warm after very long use  
in the card slot. This is normal and does not indicate  
malfunction.  
This will cause the : indicator to disappear from the  
display and the ; indicator to appear.  
Loading and Removing a Memory  
Card  
• A memory card must be positioned correctly when  
being loaded into the Digital Keyboard. Trying to force  
an improperly oriented memory card into the slot can  
damage the memory card and the slot.  
If the message “No Card” appears on the display, it means  
there is no memory card in the card slot. For details about  
what appears on the display while a card is loaded, see  
“Playing a Music File from a Memory Card” (page E-137).  
• To exit the card mode, press the C-9 (CARD) button again.  
This will cause the ; indicator to disappear from the  
display and the : indicator to appear.  
1. With the top of the memory card facing  
upwards (so you can see it), carefully insert it  
into the Digital Keyboard’s SD card slot (T-1)  
until stops with a click.  
Formatting a Memory Card  
• Format a memory card before using it for the first time.  
• Before formatting a memory card, make sure it does  
not have any valuable data stored on it.  
• The memory card format operation performed by this  
Digital Keyboard is a “quick format”. If you want to  
completely delete all of the data on the memory card,  
format it on your computer or some other device.  
Top  
1. Insert the memory card you want to format into  
2. To remove the memory card first press it into  
the Digital Keyboard’s card slot.  
the slot further.  
• Make sure the memory card is write-enabled. Check  
the position of the card’s write-protect switch to ensure  
it is not in the write-protect position.  
• This will cause the memory card to disengage and eject  
partially. Pull the memory card the rest of the way out of  
the slot.  
2. Press the C-9 (CARD) button to enter the card  
mode.  
3. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
• This displays the function menu “Play/CardUtl” screen.  
E-132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using a Memory Card  
4. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
3. Depending on the type of data you want to save  
to the memory card, perform one of the steps  
shown below.  
“CardFormat”.  
• All setup registration banks are saved as a batch. Other  
data is saved in area (data item) units.  
To save this  
Do this:  
type of data:  
One user rhythm 1. Press the L-9 ([F] USER RHYTHMS)  
button.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
specify the user rhythm number.  
One user tone  
One user DSP  
1. Press the R-12 ([L] USER TONES)  
button.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
specify the user tone number.  
5. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
• This will cause the confirmation message “Sure?” to  
appear.  
1. Perform steps 1 through 4 under “To use  
a DSP” (page E-34).  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
specify the user DSP number (101  
through 200).  
6. Press the R-14 (YES) button to format the  
memory card or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
• The message “Please Wait” will remain on the display  
while the format operation is being performed. Do not  
perform any Digital Keyboard operation while this  
message is on the display. “Complete” appears on the  
display after formatting is complete.  
One user preset  
1. While holding down the L-7 ([D] ARABIC/  
ORIENTAL) button, press the L-8 ([E]  
PIANO RHYTHMS) button to display the  
music preset screen.  
2. Press the L-9 ([F] USER RHYTHMS)  
button.  
• Formatting may take as long as a few minutes to  
complete.  
3. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
specify the user preset number.  
Saving Digital Keyboard Data to a  
Memory Card  
One song  
sequencer song  
1. Press the C-5 (SONG SEQUENCER)  
button to enter the song sequencer mode.  
2. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to  
specify the song number.  
To save Digital Keyboard data to a memory  
card  
All registration  
banks  
Press the C-10 (BANK) button to display the  
registration bank selection screen.  
1. Insert the memory card into the card slot.  
All scale memory While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
2. If the Digital Keyboard is in the card mode,  
press the C-9 (CARD) button to exit the card  
mode.  
data  
button, press the C-8 (SCALE) button to  
display the scale screen.  
4. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-9 (LOAD/SAVE) button.  
• This causes an “Xxxx Load”*1 screen like the one  
shown below to appear. The sample screen below  
shows the screen that appears from the rhythm screen.  
E-133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using a Memory Card  
5. Press the R-17 (y) button to change to the  
“Xxxx Save”*1 screen.  
• Performing the above procedure to write a song sequencer  
song to an SMF format file will save the data as SMF  
Format 0 (16 channel) data. System track data A01 through  
A16 are saved respectively to SMF 01CH through 16CH,  
while song tracks 01 through 16 are saved respectively to  
SMF 01CH through 16CH. Note that the save operation  
gives priority to the data of tracks 01 through 16. If there is  
data in any of the tracks 01 through 16 and “On” is selected  
for the “Part On/Off” setting of a track that contains data,  
the system track data (A01 through A16) for the same  
numbered track data will not be saved. Also, the note  
events of tracks that are turned off using the mixer are not  
saved.  
• To save a song sequencer song in SMF format, press  
the R-17 (y) button one more time here to display the  
“Seq SmfSave” screen. You can switch between the  
“Xxxx Load”, “Seq Save”, and “Seq SmfSave” screens  
using the R-17 (t, y) buttons.  
To batch save all Digital Keyboard data to a  
memory card  
6. Enter the file name to assign to the data when it  
is stored.  
1. Press the C-9 (CARD) button to enter the card  
Change the initial default file name “USERNAME.xxx”*2  
as described below.  
mode.  
(1) Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the cursor to  
the character you want to change.  
(2) Use the dial or the R-14 (–, +) buttons to change the  
character.  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
• This displays the function menu “Play/CardUtl” screen.  
• The characters you can select are shown below.  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“AllData” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
0
A
K
U
(
1
B
L
2
3
4
5
F
P
Z
}
6
G
Q
S
7
H
R
&
8
I
9
J
T
'
C
D
E
4. When the “All Load” screen appears, use the  
R-17 (y) button to change to the “All Save”  
screen.  
M N O  
S
_
`
V W X  
Y
{
)
-
^
@ ~  
7. After everything is the way you want, press the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
8. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to save or  
the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
• The remainder of the steps are the same as those from  
step 6 under “To save Digital Keyboard data to a  
memory card” (page E-133).  
*1 The “Xxxx” part of the file name depends the type of  
data you are saving.  
*2 The “xxx” part of the file name is a file name extension  
that depends the type of data you are saving.  
E-134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using a Memory Card  
Memory card Data Storage  
The above procedure stores Digital Keyboard data in a folder  
named MUSICDAT on the memory card.  
• The MUSICDAT folder is created automatically when you  
format the memory card on the Digital Keyboard (page  
E-132).  
7. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to load or  
the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
* The “Xxxx” part of the file name depends the type of data  
on the memory card.  
• Note that files not in the MUSICDAT folder cannot be  
loaded, deleted, or renamed by this Digital Keyboard. You  
also will not be able to load or delete any file stored in any  
subfolder inside the MUSICDAT folder.  
To batch load all Digital Keyboard memory  
data from a memory card  
1. Press the C-9 (CARD) button to enter the card  
mode.  
Loading Data from a Memory  
Card  
2. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
• This displays the function menu “Play/CardUtl” screen.  
• Make sure that all of the data you want to load is in the  
MUSICDAT folder on the memory card.  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“AllData” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
To load data to Digital Keyboard memory  
from a memory card  
• This displays the “All Load” screen.  
• The remainder of the steps are the same as those from  
step 5 under “To load data to Digital Keyboard memory  
from a memory card” (page E-135).  
1. Insert the memory card into the card slot.  
2. If the Digital Keyboard is in the card mode,  
press the C-9 (CARD) button to exit the card  
mode.  
3. Referring to the table in step 3 of the procedure  
under “To save Digital Keyboard data to a  
memory card” (page E-133), perform the  
procedure required for the type of data you  
want to load from the card.  
• All setup registration banks are loaded as a batch.  
Other data is loaded in area (data item) units.  
4. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-9 (LOAD/SAVE) button.  
• This causes an “Xxxx Load”* screen like the one shown  
below to appear. The sample screen below shows the  
screen that appears from the rhythm screen.  
5. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to display the  
file you want to import.  
6. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
E-135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using a Memory Card  
To delete a file from a memory  
card  
To rename a file on a memory  
card  
1. Insert the memory card into the card slot.  
1. Insert the memory card into the card slot.  
2. Press the C-9 (CARD) button to enter the card  
2. Press the C-9 (CARD) button to enter the card  
mode.  
mode.  
3. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
3. While holding down the R-13 (FUNCTION)  
button, press the C-17 (MENU) button.  
• This displays the function menu “Play/CardUtl” screen.  
• This displays the function menu “Play/CardUtl” screen.  
4. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“FileDelete” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
4. Use the R-17 (i, y) buttons to move the 0 to  
“FileRename” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This displays a screen for specifying the file to be  
deleted.  
• This displays a screen for specifying the file to be  
renamed.  
5. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to display the  
file you want to rename.  
6. Use the R-17 (u, i) buttons to move the  
cursor to the name character position you want  
to change, and then use the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to select the character you want.  
7. After the name is the way you want, press the  
5. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to display the  
R-16 (ENTER) button.  
file you want to delete.  
8. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to rename  
the file or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
6. Press the R-16 (ENTER) button.  
7. In response to the “Sure?” message that  
appears, press the R-14 (YES) button to delete  
or the R-14 (NO) button to cancel.  
• Pressing the R-14 (YES) button displays the message  
“Please Wait” (indicating the operation is in progress).  
Do not perform any operation while this message is on  
the display. “Complete” appears on the display after the  
operation is complete.  
• Pressing the R-14 (YES) button displays the message  
“Please Wait” (indicating the operation is in progress).  
Do not perform any operation while this message is on  
the display. “Complete” appears on the display after the  
operation is complete.  
E-136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using a Memory Card  
L-8  
C-9  
L-9  
R-14  
R-16  
R-17  
L-13  
L-14 L-16 L-18  
L-15 L-17  
5. Use the dial or R-14 (–, +) buttons to select the  
Playing a Music File from a  
Memory Card  
music file you want to play.  
You can use the Digital Keyboard to play music files you  
saved to a memory card with your computer.  
• Supported music files are SMF format 0 or 1 MIDI files  
(MID).  
• Playback of audio files (WAV, MP3, etc.) is not  
supported.  
6. To start playback, press the L-17 (PLAY/STOP)  
button.  
• At the same time playback starts, the transpose setting  
(page E-18) will change to 00 and the local control setting  
(page E-128) will change to “on”.  
• To perform a fast forward operation, hold down the  
L-15 (dFF) button. The measure number in the lower  
right corner of the display scrolls at high speed while  
the L-15 (dFF) is depressed. Releasing the button  
immediately resumes normal playback from that point.  
• To perform a fast backward operation, hold down the  
L-14 (sREW) button. Sound is muted and the  
measure number in the lower right corner of the display  
scrolls at high speed while the L-14 (sREW) is  
depressed. Releasing the button immediately resumes  
normal playback from the beginning of the measure  
whose number is displayed.  
To play a music file from a memory card  
1. Format the memory card on the Digital  
Keyboard (page E-132).  
• This will cause a folder named MUSICDAT to be  
automatically created in the memory card root  
directory.  
2. Use your computer to copy the music file you  
want to play to the MUSICDAT folder that was  
created in step 1.  
• Pressing the L-16 (PAUSE) button pauses playback.  
Press again to resume playback.  
7. To stop playback, press the L-17 (PLAY/STOP)  
• See the “Important!” note above for information about  
supported file types.  
button.  
3. Insert the memory card into the card slot.  
4. Press the C-9 (CARD) button to enter the card  
mode.  
E-137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using a Memory Card  
6. Press the L-18 (PART SELECT) button to exit  
Turning Off One Hand Part and Playing the  
Other Hand Part on the Keyboard (Part Off)  
the part on/off screen.  
When playing a music file of a piano piece that has the left  
hand and the right hand parts recorded in separate MIDI  
channels, you can turn off playback of one of the parts and  
play it on the keyboard along with playback of the other part.  
7. To start playback, press the L-17 (PLAY/STOP)  
button.  
• This starts playback of the part you turned on in step 3.  
8. To stop playback, press the L-17 (PLAY/STOP)  
1. Enter the card mode and select the MIDI file you  
button.  
want to play.  
2. Press the L-18 (PART SELECT) button.  
• The part on/off setting reverts to the initial default (both  
parts on) whenever you select a different music file.  
• This displays a “Part Select” screen like the one shown  
below, with the 0 next to “Part L”.  
3. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0  
between “Part L” (left-hand part) and “Part R”  
(right-hand part), and the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to turn the currently selected part on or  
off.  
4. Use the R-17 (y) button to move the 0 to  
“SelectCh” and then press the R-16 (ENTER)  
button.  
• This causes the screen shown below to appear.  
5. Use the R-17 (t, y) buttons to move the 0  
between “Part L” (left-hand part) and “Part R”  
(right-hand part), and the dial or R-14 (–, +)  
buttons to specify the MIDI channel for  
currently selected part.  
E-138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using a Memory Card  
Playing on the Keyboard Along with  
To repeat play a specific section of a song  
Playback of a Music File on a memory card  
1. Enter the card mode and select the MIDI file you  
You can perform the following operations and play on the  
keyboard along with playback of a music file on a memory  
card.  
• Select UPPER 1 part, UPPER 2 part, and LOWER part  
tones.  
want to play.  
2. Press the L-17 (PLAY/STOP) button to start  
playback.  
• Specify layer, split on/off, and the split point  
3. When playback reaches the measure you want  
to specify as the repeat start point, press the  
L-13 (REPEAT) button.  
The procedures for performing these operations are the same  
as those performed in the rhythm mode. For details about the  
operation, see “Layering and Splitting Tones” (page E-15).  
• The ? indicator will be flashing on the display.  
You also can use the procedure below to easily assign the  
same tone as the right-hand part or left-hand part of the music  
file to the keyboard (UPPER 1 part tone) for manual play.  
4. When playback reaches the measure you want  
to specify as the repeat end point, press the  
L-13 (REPEAT) button.  
To assign the same tone as the right-hand part or  
left-hand part of the music file to the keyboard  
• The ? indicator will stop flashing and repeat  
playback of the measures within the range you  
specified in steps 3 and 4 will start.  
1. Perform the procedure under “Turning Off One  
Hand Part and Playing the Other Hand Part on  
the Keyboard (Part Off)” (page E-138) to turn off  
the part you want to play on the keyboard.  
• The repeat range is from the beginning of the measure  
you specified in step 3 to the end of the measure you  
specified in step 4.  
• If you do not specify an end point, the end of the song  
will be the end point.  
• This step is not required if you want to play along on the  
keyboard while playing back both hand parts.  
5. To stop playback, press the L-17 (PLAY/STOP)  
button.  
2. While holding down the L-8 ([E] PIANO  
RHYTHMS) button, press the L-9 ([F] USER  
RHYTHMS) button.  
• Pressing the L-17 (PLAY/STOP) button again will  
restart repeat playback using the same start and end  
points.  
• This assigns the tone of the part that is turned off to the  
UPPER 1 part.  
• The repeat range is cleared when you select a different  
music file.  
• If both parts are on or off, the right-hand part of the  
music file is assigned to the UPPER 1 part.  
To change the playback tempo  
3. This starts playback of the music file. Play the  
See “To change the tempo setting” (page E-19).  
part you want on the keyboard.  
To adjust playback volume in accordance  
with keyboard play volume  
See “SongVol. (Song Volume)” (page E-128). For information  
about how to configure settings, see “To change the setting of  
a function menu item” (page E-125).  
To sound a pre-count at the start of playback  
See “PreCount (Song Pre-count Sound)” (page E-127). For  
information about how to configure settings, see “To change  
the setting of a function menu item” (page E-125).  
E-139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to a Computer  
You can connect the Digital Keyboard to a computer and  
2. After starting up your computer, use a  
exchange MIDI data between them. You can send play data  
from the Digital Keyboard to music software running on your  
computer, or you can send MIDI data from your computer to  
the Digital Keyboard for playback.  
commercially available USB cable to connect it  
to the Digital Keyboard.  
Digital Keyboard USB port  
USB cable  
(A-B type)  
Minimum Computer System  
Requirements  
A connector  
B connector  
The following shows the minimum computer system  
requirements for sending and receiving MIDI data. Check to  
make sure that your computer complies with these  
requirements before connecting the Digital Keyboard to it.  
Computer USB port  
• Operating System  
3. Turn on the Digital Keyboard.  
Windows® XP (SP2 or later) *1  
Windows Vista® *2  
• If this is the first time you are connecting the Digital  
Keyboard to your computer, the driver software  
required to send and receive data will be installed on  
your computer automatically.  
Windows 7® *3  
Mac OS® X (10.3.9, 10.4.11 or later, 10.5.8 or later,  
10.6.3 or later)  
*1: Windows XP Home Edition  
Windows XP Professional (32-bit)  
*2: Windows Vista (32-bit)  
4. Start up your computer’s music software.  
5. Configure the music software settings to select  
*3: Windows 7 (32-bit, 64-bit)  
one of the following as the MIDI device.  
CASIO USB-MIDI : (For Windows 7, Windows Vista,  
Mac OS X)  
• USB port  
USB Audio Device : (For Windows XP)  
• For information about how to select the MIDI device,  
see the user documentation that comes with the music  
software you are using.  
• Never connect to a computer that does not conform to  
the above requirements. Doing so can cause problems  
with your computer.  
Connecting the Digital Keyboard to Your  
Computer  
• Be sure to turn on the Digital Keyboard first before  
starting up your computer’s music software.  
• Once you are able to connect successfully for the first time,  
there is no problem with leaving the USB cable connected  
when you turn off your computer and/or Digital Keyboard.  
• You can alter the Digital Keyboard’s MIDI setup by  
changing the MIDI data send channel or other settings. For  
details, see “MIDI Group” under “Function Menu Settings”  
(page E-126).  
• For information about the relationship between each Digital  
Keyboard part (page E-38) and the MIDI IN and MIDI OUT  
channels, see “Assigning a MIDI Channel to Each Part”  
(page E-157).  
• Make sure you follow the steps of the procedure below  
exactly. Connecting incorrectly can make data send  
and receive impossible.  
1. Turn off the Digital Keyboard and then start up  
your computer.  
• Do not start up the music software on your computer  
yet!  
• This Digital Keyboard conforms to General MIDI Level 1  
(GM).  
• For detailed specifications and connections that apply to  
MIDI data send and receive by this Digital Keyboard, see  
the latest support information provided by the website at the  
following URL.  
http://world.casio.com/  
E-140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to a Computer  
Storing and Loading Digital  
Keyboard Memory Data  
Using Rhythm (Auto  
Accompaniment) Data from  
another Model  
You can use the procedures in this section to import and use  
rhythm data from another model.  
You can transfer song sequencer songs, user rhythms, and  
other data in Digital Keyboard memory to a computer for  
storage. You also can load Auto Accompaniment data you  
download from the CASIO website to the Digital Keyboard,  
which greatly expands the Auto Accompaniment patterns  
available to you. A special Data Manager application is  
required in order to transfer data to and from the Digital  
Keyboard.  
Rhythm Data Compatibility  
• You may experience some abnormalities when trying to  
play back rhythm data created for another model.  
• Note that some of the models described below are  
available only in certain geographic locations.  
Data Types Supported for Data Transfer  
Downloading Data Manager  
The same types of data that you can store to or recall from a  
memory card (page E-131) can be transferred to and from the  
Digital Keyboard.  
Models whose rhythm data is compatible with the  
1
Digital Keyboard  
Rhythm data (filename extension: ac7) of the models  
below can be imported to the Digital Keyboard and used  
as-is.  
To download Data Manager  
Conversely, rhythm data from this Digital Keyboard can be  
used on these models.  
1. Go to the CASIO WORLDWIDE site at the  
following URL.  
AP-6/AP-620/AT-3/AT-5/CDP-200R/CTK-4000/  
CTK-5000/CTK-5000SK/CTK-6000/CTK-7000/PX-330/  
WK-200/WK-210/WK-500/WK-6500/WK-7500  
http://world.casio.com/  
2. At the site, select a geographic area or country.  
Models whose rhythm data can be used as-is on the  
Digital Keyboard  
2
3. After accessing the area site, navigate to the  
minimum computer system requirements for  
Data Manager for this product.  
Rhythm data (filename extensions: z00 and ckf) of the  
models below can be imported to the Digital Keyboard and  
used as-is. Rhythm data for these models can be  
downloaded from the CASIO MUSIC SITE  
(http://music.casio.com/).  
• You should be able to find a link to Data Manager  
information on the product introduction page of this  
product. If you cannot find such a link, use the search  
form of the area site where you are located to enter the  
model name of this product and search for it.  
• Note that site contents are subject to change without  
notice.  
CTK-671/CTK-691/CTK-900/PX-410R/PX-575R/  
WK-3000/WK-3200/WK-3300/WK-3500/WK-3700/  
WK-3800/WK-8000  
Rhythm data from this Digital Keyboard cannot be used on  
these models.  
4. Check if your computer system complies with  
the minimum requirements for Data Manager.  
Models whose rhythm data can be used on the Digital  
Keyboard following conversion  
Rhythm data (filename extensions: cpt and ept) can be  
imported to the Digital Keyboard and used after it is  
converted with Rhythm Converter to compatible data  
3
5. Download Data Manager and its user’s guide to  
your computer.  
6. Follow the procedure in the user’s guide that  
you downloaded in step 5 to install and use  
Data Manager.  
(described in  
above). Rhythm Converter can be  
2
downloaded from the CASIO MUSIC SITE  
(http://music.casio.com/).  
CTK-731/CTK-738/CTK-811/WK-1800  
Rhythm data from this Digital Keyboard cannot be used on  
these models.  
E-141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Connecting to a Computer  
If the data is on  
this type of  
media:  
Importing and Transferring Rhythm Data  
from Other Models  
Do this:  
You can transfer rhythm data from other models by loading it  
from a memory card, or by using Data Manager to transfer the  
data from a computer to Digital Keyboard memory. For  
information about actual operations, see “Importing Data from  
Various Storage Media” (page E-142).  
2GB to 32GB  
capacity memory  
card  
1. Depending on the location of the data on the  
memory card, perform either of the following  
operations.  
• If the data is in the MUSICDAT folder on the  
memory card, advance directly to step 2 of  
this procedure.  
• If the data is not in the MUSICDAT folder on  
the memory card, move it to the MUSICDAT  
folder. If there is no MUSICDAT folder on the  
memory card, create a new folder in the  
memory card’s root directory and name it  
MUSICDAT. Next, move the data to the  
folder.  
2. Perform the procedure under “To load data to  
Digital Keyboard memory from a memory card”  
(page E-135).  
• Use of a memory card with a capacity that is less than 2GB  
is not supported. If you want to use other model rhythm  
data that is on a memory card with capacity less than 2GB,  
you need either to copy the data to a supported memory  
card on the Digital Keyboard, or use Data Manager to  
transfer the data from a computer to the Digital Keyboard.  
For more information, see “Importing Data from Various  
Storage Media” (page E-142). Also note that rhythm data  
from some models needs to be converted before it can be  
used on this Digital Keyboard. For more information, see  
“Rhythm Data Compatibility” (page E-141).  
Unsupported  
memory card  
(capacity less  
than 2GB, etc.)  
1. Copy the data on the memory card to the  
computer’s local disk.  
2. Copy the data in step 1 from the computer’s  
local disk to the MUSICDAT folder of a memory  
card (2GB to 32GB card) that was formatted on  
the Digital Keyboard.  
3. Perform the procedure under “To load data to  
Digital Keyboard memory from a memory card”  
(page E-135).  
Importing Data from Various  
Storage Media  
Or:  
1. Copy the data on the memory card to the  
computer’s local disk.  
2. Perform the procedure under “To download  
Data Manager” (page E-141).  
• For details about how to transfer data from  
the computer to the Digital Keyboard, see  
the user documentation that comes with  
Data Manager.  
The procedure you need to use to import or transfer rhythm  
data to Digital Keyboard memory depends on the media  
(computer local disk, memory card) where the data is  
currently stored. This section explains each of the required  
procedures.  
• For details about Data Manager, see “Storing and Loading  
Digital Keyboard Memory Data” (page E-141).  
• For information about the types of memory cards supported  
by the Digital Keyboard, see “Using a Memory Card” (page  
E-131).  
To load rhythm data into Digital Keyboard  
memory  
Perform one of the procedures below, depending on the type  
of data you want to load.  
If the data is on  
this type of  
media:  
Do this:  
Computer local  
disk  
1. Perform the procedure under “To download  
Data Manager” (page E-141).  
• For details about how to transfer data from  
the computer to the Digital Keyboard, see  
the user documentation that comes with  
Data Manager.  
Or:  
1. Copy the data from your computer’s local disk  
to the MUSICDAT folder on a 2GB to 32GB  
capacity memory card that has been formatted  
on the Digital Keyboard.  
2. Perform the procedure under “To load data to  
Digital Keyboard memory from a memory card”  
(page E-135).  
E-142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
Error Messages  
Display  
Message  
Cause  
Required Action  
Format  
1. The current memory card format is not compatible 1. Format the memory card on the Digital Keyboard  
with this Digital Keyboard.  
(page E-132).  
2. The memory card capacity is greater than 32GB.  
2. Use a memory card with a capacity of 32GB or  
less.  
3. You are trying to use an SDXC card.  
3. SDXC cards not supported. Use an SD or SDHC  
memory card.  
4. There is something wrong with the memory card.  
4. Use a different memory card.  
Card Full  
There is not enough room available on the memory  
card.  
Delete some of the files on the memory card to make  
room for new data (page E-136), or use a different  
card.  
Card R/W  
No Card  
Memory card data is corrupted.  
Use a different memory card.  
1. The memory card is not loaded correctly in the  
Digital Keyboard’s card slot.  
1. Correctly load the memory card into the card slot.  
2. The memory card was removed while some  
operation was in progress.  
2. Do not remove the memory card while any  
operation is in progress.  
No Data  
No File  
You tried to save a Digital Keyboard user area (user Select a user area that contains data.  
rhythm, user rhythm song, etc.) that does not contain  
any data to the memory card.  
1. There is no MUSICDAT folder (page E-135) on the 1. Create a MUSICDAT folder on the memory card or  
memory card.  
format the memory card on the Digital Keyboard  
(page E-132).  
2. There is no loadable or playable data in the  
MUSICDAT folder.  
2. Move the file you want to load or play into the  
memory card’s MUSICDAT folder.  
Not SMF0/1  
Protect  
You are attempting to play back SMF Format 2 file.  
This Digital Keyboard supports playback of SMF  
Format 0 or Format 1 only.  
The memory card is write-protected.  
Use the memory card’s write protect switch to enable  
writing.  
Read Only  
A read-only file with the same name you are trying to • Use a different name to save the new file.  
use is already stored on the memory card.  
• Remove the read-only attribute from the existing  
file and overwrite it with the new file.  
• Use a different memory card.  
Size Over  
1. The data on the memory card is too big to play.  
2. The data you are trying to load is too large.  
1. This Digital Keyboard supports playback of song  
data files with a maximum size of about 320KB.  
2. The following is the approximate maximum data  
sizes (per data item) when loading data into Digital  
Keyboard memory.  
User rhythm: 32KB  
Song sequencer song: 159KB  
User preset: 8KB  
A total of approximately 128KB of user presets  
(total of all 100 user presets) can be loaded.  
Wrong Data  
Meas. Limit  
1. The memory card data is corrupted.  
Use a different memory card.  
2. The memory card contains data that is not  
supported by this Digital Keyboard.  
You tried to perform an operation during song  
sequencer song editing or user music preset editing  
that would cause the number of measures in the song  
or chord progression to exceed 999.  
Make sure your edits do not cause the number of  
measures to exceed the 999-measure limit.  
B
E-143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
Display  
Message  
Cause  
Required Action  
Memory Full  
1. There is not enough memory capacity required for 1. To record new data of some part of some  
pattern sequencer operations.  
accompaniment pattern, clear another part and/or  
another accompaniment patterns. If you want to  
use Easy Edit, select a different rhythm from the  
one that was selected when the error message  
appeared.  
2. Remaining memory capacity became too low  
during music preset editing.  
2. Referring to “To clear user preset data” (page  
E-54), delete user presets you no longer need in  
order to free up memory.  
3. There is not enough memory capacity required for 3. Delete other tracks and/or songs to free up memory  
song sequencer operations. space.  
File Name  
Card Size  
When renaming a file on a memory card, attempting Use a different name.  
to specify a file name that is already used.  
Memory card capacity is not enough for audio  
recording and playback.  
Use a memory card with a capacity at least 2GB.  
E-144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
Troubleshooting  
Symptom  
Action  
Included Accessories  
I can’t find something that should be  
included with the product.  
Carefully check inside all of the packing materials.  
Power Requirements  
Power will not turn on.  
• Check the AC adaptor or make sure that the batteries are facing correctly (page  
E-9).  
• Replace the batteries with new ones or switch over to AC adaptor power (page  
E-9).  
• You may have tried to perform some operation while the “Please Wait” message  
was dispalyed, which caused an internal problem. If other measures do not  
correct this problem, perform the operation below to turn on power.  
Warning!  
The following operation will delete all Digital Keyboard data and return all  
settings to their initial factory defaults.  
While holding down the R-2 ([B] E.PIANO) and R-5 ([E] STRINGS) buttons,  
press the L-1 (POWER) button to turn on power.  
The Digital Keyboard outputs a loud sound Replace the batteries with new ones or switch over to AC adaptor power (page  
and then suddenly powers down.  
E-9).  
The Digital Keyboard suddenly powers  
down after a few minutes.  
This happens when Auto Power Off (page E-13) is triggered.  
Display  
The display keeps going out or is flashing. Replace the batteries with new ones or switch over to AC adaptor power (page  
E-9).  
Screen contents are visible only from  
straight ahead.  
This is due to production limitations. It does not indicate malfunction.  
Sound  
Nothing happens when I press any  
keyboard key.  
• Adjust the main volume setting (page E-13).  
• Check if something is plugged into the T-4 (PHONES) jack on the back of the  
Digital Keyboard.  
• Turn power off and then back on to initialize all keyboard settings (page E-13).  
Nothing happens or notes do not play  
Press the L-18 (ACCOMP ON/OFF) button to disable chord input with chord  
normally when I play on the left side of the keyboard (page E-26).  
keyboard.  
Nothing happens when I start an Auto  
Accompaniment.  
• With rhythms E:026 to E:035, nothing will sound until you play a chord on the  
keyboard. Try playing a chord (page E-28).  
• Check and adjust the accompaniment volume setting (page E-128).  
• If there is no user rhythm stored in memory, Auto Accompaniment will not start  
when you press the L-17 (START/STOP) button while a rhythm in the range of  
F:001 to F:100 is selected (page E-26).  
• Turn power off and then back on to initialize all Digital Keyboard settings (page  
E-13).  
The metronome does not sound.  
• Check and adjust the metronome volume setting (page E-128).  
• Turn power off and then back on to initialize all Digital Keyboard settings (page  
E-13).  
Notes keep sounding, without stopping.  
• Turn power off and then back on to initialize all Digital Keyboard settings (page  
E-13).  
• Replace the batteries with new ones or switch over to AC adaptor power (page  
E-9).  
E-145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
Symptom  
Action  
Some notes are cut off while they are  
playing.  
Notes are cut off whenever the number of notes being sounded exceeds the  
maximum polyphony value of 64 (21 to 32 for some tones). This does not indicate  
malfunction.  
The volume or tone setting I configured  
has changed.  
• Adjust the main volume setting (page E-13).  
• Turn power off and then back on to initialize all Digital Keyboard settings (page  
E-13).  
• Replace the batteries with new ones or switch over to AC adaptor power (page  
E-9).  
Output volume does not change even  
though I change my keyboard pressure.  
• Change the Touch Response setting (page E-126).  
• Turn power off and then back on to initialize all Digital Keyboard settings (page  
E-13).  
In certain keyboard ranges, the volume  
and tone quality sound are slightly  
different from those in other keyboard  
ranges.  
This is due to system limitations. It does not indicate malfunction.  
With some tones, octaves do not change This is due to system limitations. It does not indicate malfunction.  
at the far ends of the keyboard.  
The pitch of the notes does not match  
other accompanying instruments or  
sounds strange when played along with  
other instruments.  
• When the B indicator is displayed, it means that the transpose setting  
(page E-18) has been used to change the pitch of the keyboard. Return the  
transpose setting to 00.  
• When the C indicator is displayed, it means that the scale setting (page  
E-22) has been used to change the Digital Keyboard’s initial default setting. Use  
the procedure under “Selecting a Preset Scale” (page E-23) to change to the  
“Equal” preset scale.  
• Turn power off and then back on to initialize all Digital Keyboard settings (page  
E-13).  
The reverb of notes seems to change  
suddenly.  
• Check and adjust the reverb setting (page E-33).  
• Turn power off and then back on to initialize all Digital Keyboard settings (page  
E-13).  
Operation  
Tone, rhythm, and other settings revert to The Digital Keyboard may be configured to restore default settings (factory default  
their initial defaults whenever you turn on settings or settings registered by you) when power is turned on. If you want the  
the Digital Keyboard.  
Digital Keyboard to remember its last setup and restore it the next time it is turned  
on, select “on” for the Auto Resume setting (page E-129).  
Computer Connection  
I can’t exchange data between the Digital • Check to make sure that the USB cable is connected to the Digital Keyboard and  
Keyboard and a computer.  
computer, and that the device is selected correctly with your computer’s music  
software settings (page E-140).  
• Turn off the Digital Keyboard and then exit the music software on your computer.  
Next, turn the Digital Keyboard back on and then restart the music software on  
your computer.  
E-146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
Specifications  
Models  
AT-3 / AT-5  
Keyboard  
AT-3: 61 standard-size keys  
AT-5: 76 standard-size keys  
Touch Response  
Maximum Polyphony  
Tones  
2 types, Off  
64 notes (32 for certain tones)  
Built-in Tones  
User Tones  
800  
Up to 100 (Tone Editor)  
Layer, Split  
1 to 10, Off  
1 to 5  
Functions  
Reverb  
Chorus  
DSP  
Preset DSP  
100  
User DSP  
Up to 100  
Oriental Scale  
Scale Fine Tune  
Preset Scales  
Scale Memory  
Metronome  
99 cents  
17  
4
Beats per Measure  
Tempo Range  
Auto Accompaniment  
Built-in Rhythms  
User Rhythms  
Demo Songs  
Registration  
Song Sequencer  
0, 2 to 6  
30 to 255  
250  
Up to 100 (Pattern Sequencer)  
5 songs  
96 (6 setups × 16 banks)  
Real-time recording, playback  
Punch-in recording  
Keyboard Play  
5 songs, 17 tracks  
Memory Capacity  
Approximately 30,000 notes (total for 5 songs)  
Audio Recording and Playback  
Functions  
Requirement  
Recording  
An SD or SDHC memory card, 2GB to 32GB  
Recording of keyboard play, song sequencer song playback, sound input from MIC IN jack  
and INST IN jack  
Up to 5 audio files (maximum recording time: approximately 13 minutes for a single audio  
file)  
Playback  
Up to 999 files (including files used for recording)  
Mixer  
32 parts (A01-A16/B01-B16)  
Master parameters, DSP parameters, Part parameters, MIC/INST parameters  
Other Functions  
Transpose  
1 octaves (–12 to +12 semitones)  
UPPER 1/UPPER 2/LOWER 2 octaves  
A4 = 415.5 - 440.0 - 465.9Hz  
305 built-in, plus 100 user presets  
250  
Octave Shift  
Tuning  
Music Preset  
One Touch Preset  
Auto Harmonize  
Arpeggiator  
12 types  
150 types  
MIDI  
16 multi-timbre received, GM Level 1 standard  
Pitch Bend Wheel  
Pitch Bend Range  
0 to 24 semitones  
B
E-147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
Memory Cards  
Supported Memory Cards  
Functions  
SD or SDHC memory cards, 2GB to 32GB  
SMF playback, file storage, file recall, file delete, card format  
Inputs/Outputs  
USB port  
TYPE B  
Sustain/Assignable jack  
Phones jack  
Standard jack (sustain, sostenuto, soft, start/stop)  
Stereo standard jack  
Line Out R, L/MONO jacks  
Standard jack × 2  
Output Impedance: 2.3kΩ, Output Voltage: 1.5V (RMS) MAX  
Audio In jack  
Inst In Jack  
Mic In jack  
Stereo mini jack  
Input Impedance: 9kΩ, Input Sensitivity: 200mV  
Standard jack  
Input Impedance: 9kΩ, Input Sensitivity: 200mV  
Standard jack (connect a dynamic microphone only)  
Input Impedance: 3kΩ, Input Sensitivity: 10mV  
Power Jack  
Power Supply  
Batteries  
12V DC  
2-way  
6 D-size zinc-carbon batteries or alkaline batteries  
Approximately 4 hours continuous operation on alkaline batteries  
AD-A12150LW  
Battery Life  
AC Adaptor  
Auto Power Off  
Approximately 6 minutes after last key operation during battery use,  
approximately 4 hours after last key operation during AC adaptor use. Auto Power Off can be  
disabled.  
Speakers  
12 cm × 2 + 3 cm × 2 (Output: 7.0W + 7.0W)  
Power Consumption  
Dimensions  
12V = 18W  
AT-3: 94.5 × 37.8 × 13.2 cm (37 1/4 × 14 7/8 × 5 3/16 inch)  
AT-5: 118.7 × 39.9 × 14.9 cm (46 3/4 × 15 3/4 × 5 7/8 inch)  
Weight  
AT-3: Approximately 6.8kg (15.0 lbs) (without batteries)  
AT-5: Approximately 8.9kg (19.6 lbs) (without batteries)  
• Design and specifications are subject to change without notice.  
E-148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
Operating Precautions  
Be sure to read and observe the following operating  
precautions.  
Location  
Avoid the following locations for this product.  
• Areas exposed to direct sunlight and high humidity  
• Areas subjected to temperature extremes  
• Near a radio, TV, video deck, or tuner  
The above devices will not cause malfunction of the  
product, but the product can cause interference in the audio  
or video of a nearby device.  
User Maintenance  
• Never use benzine, alcohol, thinner, or other chemical  
agents to clean the product.  
• To clean the product or its keyboard, wipe with a soft cloth  
moistened in a weak solution of water and a mild neutral  
detergent. Wring all excess moisture from the cloth before  
wiping.  
Included and Optional Accessories  
Use only accessories that are specified for use with this  
product. Use of unauthorized accessories creates the risk of  
fire, electric shock, and personal injury.  
AC Adaptor Handling Precautions  
• Use a power outlet that is easily accessible so you can  
unplug the AC adaptor when a malfunction occurs or  
whenever else you need to do so.  
• The AC adaptor is intended for indoor use only. Do not use  
it where it might be exposed to splashing or moisture. Do  
not place any container, such as a flower vase, that  
contains liquid on the AC adaptor.  
• Store the AC adaptor in a dry place.  
• Use the AC adaptor in an open, well-ventilated area.  
• Never cover the AC adaptor with newspaper, a table cloth,  
a curtain, or any other similar item.  
• Unplug the AC adaptor from the power outlet if you do not  
plan to use the product for a long time.  
• Never try to repair the AC adaptor or modify it in any way.  
• AC adaptor operating environment  
Temperature: 0 to 40°C  
Humidity: 10% to 90% RH  
• Output polarity: &  
Weld Lines  
Lines may be visible on the exterior of the product. These are  
“weld lines” that result from the plastic molding process. They  
are not cracks or scratches.  
Musical Instrument Etiquette  
Always be aware of others around you whenever using this  
product. Be especially careful when playing late at night to  
keep the volume at levels that do not disturb others. Other  
steps you can take when playing late at night are closing  
windows and using headphones.  
E-149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
DSP Effect List  
Preset DSP List  
The table below shows the preset DSPs that can be selected by the procedure under “To use a DSP” (page E-34).  
• The “Number” column shows DSP numbers, while the “Screen Name” shows the DSP name that appears on the display.  
• The DSPs of this Digital Keyboard consist of the 46 “types” shown in the “DSP Type List” (page E-151). A preset DSP is a  
variation that is derived from one of these 46 types.  
Number  
001  
002  
003  
004  
005  
006  
007  
008  
009  
010  
011  
012  
013  
014  
015  
016  
017  
018  
019  
020  
021  
022  
023  
024  
025  
026  
027  
028  
029  
030  
031  
032  
033  
034  
035  
036  
037  
038  
039  
040  
041  
042  
043  
044  
045  
046  
047  
048  
049  
050  
Screen Name  
Comp 1  
Comp 2  
Type Number  
02  
02  
04  
04  
07  
07  
07  
09  
09  
09  
09  
09  
24  
24  
41  
08  
08  
08  
08  
25  
10  
10  
10  
10  
10  
11  
11  
11  
26  
36  
36  
36  
38  
38  
38  
6
Number  
051  
052  
053  
054  
055  
056  
057  
058  
059  
060  
061  
062  
063  
064  
065  
066  
067  
068  
069  
070  
071  
072  
073  
074  
075  
076  
077  
078  
079  
080  
081  
082  
083  
084  
085  
086  
087  
088  
089  
090  
091  
092  
093  
094  
095  
096  
097  
098  
099  
100  
Screen Name  
RefPan 1  
Type Number  
42  
42  
12  
12  
12  
12  
12  
01  
01  
01  
01  
22  
17  
17  
18  
18  
16  
16  
20  
20  
21  
21  
19  
19  
15  
15  
03  
03  
03  
30  
23  
34  
34  
35  
35  
31  
31  
32  
32  
32  
29  
29  
29  
29  
33  
40  
14  
13  
13  
13  
RefPan 2  
Rotary 1  
Rotary 2  
Rotary 3  
Rotary 4  
Rotary 5  
Wah 1  
Wah 2  
Wah 3  
Wah 4  
CmpWah  
WahCho 1  
WahCho 2  
WahFln 1  
WahFln 2  
WahDst 1  
WahDst 2  
WahTrm 1  
WahTrm 2  
WahPan 1  
WahPan 2  
WahRef 1  
WahRef 2  
WahCmp 1  
WahCmp 2  
Dist 1  
Enhance1  
Enhance2  
Phaser 1  
Phaser 2  
Phaser 3  
Chorus 1  
Chorus 2  
Chorus 3  
Chorus 4  
Chorus 5  
CmpCho 1  
CmpCho 2  
RefCho  
Flanger1  
Flanger2  
Flanger3  
Flanger4  
CmpFln  
Delay 1  
Delay 2  
Delay 3  
Delay 4  
Delay 5  
Reflect1  
Reflect2  
Reflect3  
CmpRef  
ChoRef 1  
ChoRef 2  
ChoRef 3  
FlnRef 1  
FlnRef 2  
FlnRef 3  
Tremolo  
CmpTrm  
TrmRef  
TrmCho 1  
TrmCho 2  
TrmFln 1  
TrmFln 2  
TrmDst 1  
TrmDst 2  
AutoPan  
CmpPan  
ChoPan 1  
ChoPan 2  
FlnPan 1  
FlnPan 2  
Dist 2  
Dist 3  
DstCmp  
CmpDst  
DstTrm 1  
DstTrm 2  
DstPan 1  
DstPan 2  
DstCho 1  
DstCho 2  
DstFln 1  
DstFln 2  
DstFln 3  
DstWah 1  
DstWah 2  
DstWah 3  
DstWah 4  
DstRef  
27  
46  
44  
44  
45  
45  
43  
43  
05  
28  
37  
37  
39  
39  
RefDst  
Lo-Fi  
RingMod1  
RingMod2  
RingMod3  
E-150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
DSP Type List  
All of the Digital Keyboard’s preset DSPs belong to one of the DSP types shown in the table below. When creating a user DSP  
(page E-35) or when using the tone editor (page E-44) to edit the DSP applied to a tone, you need to select one of the DSP types  
in the table.  
• Type numbers 01 through 14 are single type DSPs, while numbers 15 through 46 are dual type DSPs. A single type DSP is one  
with a single structure, while a dual type is a combination of two single type DSPs.  
• The name of a dual DSP is formed by its two constituent single DSP names, in the order that they are applied. For example, type  
15 named “Wah-Compressor” connects in line to “Wah” and “Compressor”, in that sequence.  
Type Number  
DSP Type Name  
Wah  
Compressor  
Distortion  
Enhancer  
AutoPan  
Tremolo  
Phaser  
Flanger  
Chorus  
Delay  
Reflection  
Rotary  
RingModulator  
Lo-Fi  
Wah-Compressor  
Wah-Distortion  
Wah-Chorus  
Wah-Flanger  
Wah-Reflection  
Wah-Tremolo  
Wah-AutoPan  
Compressor-Wah  
Screen Name  
Wah  
Comp  
Type Number  
DSP Type Name  
Compressor-Chorus  
Compressor-Flanger  
Compressor-Reflection CmpRef  
Compressor-Tremolo CmpTrm  
Compressor-AutoPan CmpPan  
Distortion-Wah DstWah  
Distortion-Compressor DstCmp  
Distortion-Chorus  
Distortion-Flanger  
Distortion-Reflection  
Distortion-Tremolo  
Distortion-AutoPan  
Chorus-Reflection  
Chorus-AutoPan  
Flanger-Reflection  
Flanger-AutoPan  
Reflection-Distortion  
Reflection-Chorus  
Reflection-AutoPan  
Tremolo-Distortion  
Tremolo-Chorus  
Screen Name  
CmpCho  
CmpFln  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
Dist  
Enhance  
AutoPan  
Tremolo  
Phaser  
Flanger  
Chorus  
Delay  
Reflect  
Rotary  
RingMod  
Lo-Fi  
WahCmp  
WahDst  
WahCho  
WahFln  
WahRef  
WahTrm  
WahPan  
CmpWah  
DstCho  
DstFln  
DstRef  
DstTrm  
DstPan  
ChoRef  
ChoPan  
FlnRef  
FlnPan  
RefDst  
RefCho  
RefPan  
TrmDst  
TrmCho  
TrmFln  
TrmRef  
Tremolo-Flanger  
Tremolo-Reflection  
Compressor-Distortion CmpDst  
• For details about parameters that can be configured with each DSP type, refer to the sections shown in the table below.  
For information about this DSP type:  
Single type (Type numbers 01 through 14)  
Dual type (Type numbers 15 through 46)  
Go here:  
Single Type DSP Parameters (page E-152)  
Dual Type DSP Parameters (page E-154)  
E-151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
04: Enhancer  
DSP Parameter List  
Phase shifts low-range sounds and high-range sounds of the  
input signal to enhance the signal’s profile.  
Parameters and Value Ranges:  
1 :Low Frequency (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the low range enhancer frequency.  
2 :Low Phase (0 to 127)  
Single Type DSP Parameters  
01: Wah  
This is a “wah” effect that can automatically affect the  
frequency using an LFO.  
Parameters and Value Ranges:  
1 :Resonance (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the phase shift amount of the low-range enhancer.  
3 :High Frequency (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the high range enhancer frequency.  
Adjusts the strength of resonance.  
4 :High Phase (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the phase shift amount of the high-range  
enhancer.  
2 :Manual (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the wah filter reference frequency.  
3 :LFO Rate (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the LFO rate.  
4 :LFO Depth (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the LFO depth.  
5 :LFO Waveform (off, sin, tri, random)  
Selects the LFO waveform.  
05: Auto Pan  
Performs continual left-right panning of the input signal using  
an LFO.  
Parameters and Value Ranges:  
1 :LFO Rate (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the panning rate.  
2 :LFO Depth (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the panning depth.  
3 :LFO Waveform (sin, tri)  
Selects the LFO waveform.  
02: Compressor  
Compresses the input signal, which can have the effect of  
suppressing level variation and make it possible to sustain  
dampened sounds longer.  
Parameters and Value Ranges:  
1 :Attack (0 to 127)  
06: Tremolo  
Adjusts the volume of the input signal using an LFO.  
Parameters and Value Ranges:  
1 :LFO Rate (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the attack amount of the input signal. A smaller  
value causes prompt compressor operation, which  
suppresses the attack of the input signal. A larger values  
delays compressor operation, which causes the attack of  
the input signal to be output as-is.  
Adjusts the tremolo rate.  
2 :Release (0 to 127)  
2 :LFO Depth (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the tremolo depth.  
3 :LFO Waveform (sin, tri)  
Selects the LFO waveform.  
Adjusts the time from the point the input signal drops  
below a certain level until the compression operation is  
stopped. When an attack feeling is desired (no  
compression at the onset of sound), set this parameter to  
as low a value as possible. To have compression applied  
at all times, set a high value.  
07: Phaser  
Produces a distinctive pulsating, broad sound by using an  
LFO to change the phase of the input signal and then mixes it  
with the original input signal.  
Parameters and Value Ranges:  
1 :Resonance (0 to 127)  
3 :Level (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the output level.  
4 :Threshold (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the volume level at which the compression  
operation starts.  
Adjusts the strength of the resonance.  
03: Distortion  
Digital distortion that applies an overtone to the input signal  
and distorts it.  
Parameters and Value Ranges:  
1 :Gain (0 to 127)  
2 :LFO Rate (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the LFO rate.  
3 :LFO Depth (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the LFO depth.  
4 :LFO Waveform (sin, tri, random)  
Selects the LFO waveform.  
Adjusts the input signal gain.  
2 :Level (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the output level.  
E-152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
08: Flanger  
11: Reflection  
Applies wildly pulsating and metallic reverberation to sounds.  
LFO waveform is selectable.  
An effector that extracts early reflections from reverb. Applies  
acoustic presence to sounds.  
Parameters and Value Ranges:  
1 :LFO Rate (0 to 127)  
Parameters and Value Ranges:  
1 :Type (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8)  
Adjusts the LFO rate.  
Selects from among the eight available reflection patterns.  
2 :LFO Depth (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the LFO depth.  
2 :Feedback (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the repeat of the reflected sound.  
3 :LFO Waveform (sin, tri, random)  
Selects the LFO waveform.  
12: Rotary  
4 :Feedback (0 to 127)  
This is a rotary speaker simulator.  
Parameters and Value Ranges:  
1 :Overdrive Gain (0, 1, 2, 3)  
Adjusts overdrive gain.  
Adjusts the strength of feedback.  
09: Chorus  
Gives sounds depth and breadth. Chorus type is selectable.  
Parameters and Value Ranges:  
1 :LFO Rate (0 to 127)  
2 :Overdrive Level (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the overdrive output level.  
3 :Speed (Slow, Fast)  
Adjusts the LFO rate.  
Switches the speed mode between fast and slow.  
2 :LFO Depth (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the LFO depth.  
4 :Brake (Rotate, Stop)  
Stops speaker rotation.  
3 :LFO Waveform (sin, tri)  
Selects the LFO waveform.  
4 :Feedback (0 to 127)  
5 :Fall Acceleration (0 to 127)  
Adjusts acceleration when the speed mode is switched  
from fast to slow.  
Adjusts the strength of feedback  
5 :Type (mono, stereo, tri)  
Selects the chorus type.  
6 :Rise Acceleration (0 to 127)  
Adjusts acceleration when the speed mode is switched  
from slow to fast.  
7 :Slow Rate (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the speaker rotation speed in the slow speed  
mode.  
8 :Fast Rate (0 to 127)  
10: Delay  
Delays the input signal and feeds it back to create a repeating  
effect and give sounds more breadth.  
Parameters and Value Ranges:  
1 :Delay Time (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the speaker rotation speed in the fast speed  
mode.  
Adjusts the delay time.  
2 :Feedback (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the repeat of the delay.  
3 :Ratio Lch (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the delay time of the left channel. This value is a  
ratio of the value specified for Delay Time.  
4 :Ratio Rch (0 to 127)  
13: Ring Modulator  
Multiplies the input signal with an internal oscillator signal to  
create a metallic sound.  
Parameters and Value Ranges:  
1 :OSC Frequency (0 to 127)  
Sets the reference frequency of the internal oscillator.  
2 :LFO Rate (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the LFO rate.  
Adjusts the delay time of the right channel. This value is a  
ratio of the value specified for Delay Time.  
3 :LFO Depth (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the LFO depth.  
5 :Wet Level (0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5)  
Adjusts the level of the delay sound.  
4 :Type (1, 2, 3)  
6 :Type (1, 2)  
1 :Outputs the ring modulated signal only.  
Selects the delay type.  
1 :Delay repeat determined by Delay Time.  
2 :Outputs the ring modulated signal and the input signal.  
2 :Delay repeat determined by Delay Time and Ratio L/R.  
3 :Outputs a signal with a chorus effect applied to 2 (ring  
modulated signal and input signal).  
Important!  
When adjusting the delay time and type, certain settings can  
result in a switching sound in the delay.  
E-153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
14: Lo-Fi  
Applies various types of noise to the input signal to reproduce  
a retro Lo-Fi sound.  
Includes wow and flutter for rotational fluctuation like that in  
tapes and records, a Noise 1 generator that generates  
continual FM radio type, and a Noise 2 generator that  
generates record play types scratch noise.  
Parameters and Value Ranges:  
Dual Type DSP Parameters  
Dual type DSPs are configured by combining two different  
single type DSPs. Use the procedure below to determine what  
parameters that can be configured for each dual type DSP,  
and the operation, and setting ranges of dual type DSPs.  
Example: Type number 29: Distortion-Wah  
1. The DSP type name has two parts: a left side part and a  
right side part.  
Distortion-Wah 3 “Distortion” and “Wah”  
1 :Wow and Flutter Rate (0 to 127)  
2. Find out what parameters you can configure by looking up  
the left side part of a dual type DSP in the “Type Name”  
column of the table below.  
Adjusts the wow and flutter rate.  
2 :Wow and Flutter Depth (0 to 127)  
Adjusts the wow and flutter depth.  
3 :Noise1 Level (0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5)  
Adjusts the level of Noise Generator 1.  
4 :Noise2 Level (0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5)  
Adjusts the level of Noise Generator 2.  
5 :Noise2 Density (0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5)  
Type Name  
Configurable Parameters  
LFO Waveform  
LFO Rate  
LFO Depth  
Wah  
Adjusts the frequency of Noise Generator 2.  
6 :Bit (0, 1, 2, 3)  
Distortion  
Chorus  
Gain  
Level  
Distorts the sound. A larger number produces greater  
distortion.  
LFO Waveform  
LFO Rate  
LFO Depth  
Important!  
Raising the noise level while a note is not sounding will cause  
noise to sound, even if there is no input signal.  
Flanger  
LFO Waveform  
LFO Rate  
LFO Depth  
Reflection  
Feedback  
Compressor  
Threshold  
Level  
Auto Pan  
Tremolo  
LFO Waveform  
LFO Rate  
LFO Depth  
LFO Waveform  
LFO Rate  
LFO Depth  
3. Find the same type names in the table under “Single Type  
DSP Parameters” on pages E-152 through E-154, and note  
the operation and setting ranges of the items that are the  
same as those shown in the “Configurable Parameters”  
column of the above table.  
• In our “Distortion-Wah” example, the left side part of the  
name is “Distortion” so we can see in the above table  
that “Gain” and “Level” parameters can be configured.  
You can find out about the operations and setting ranges  
of “Gain” and “Level” by referring to “03: Distortion” on  
page E-152.  
4. Next, repeat steps 2 and 3 above for the right side part of  
the dual type DSP parameter name.  
• The parameter numbers that appear on the parameter  
setting screen start from 1, and the number is  
incremented for each successive parameter.  
The parameter numbers of our “Distortion-Wah” example  
would be as shown below.  
1: Gain  
2: Level  
3: LFO Waveform  
4: LFO Rate  
5: LFO Depth  
E-154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
Fingered 3, Full Range Chords  
Fingering Guide  
In addition to the chords that can be fingered with Fingered 1  
and Fingered 2, the following chords also are recognized.  
Fingered 1, Fingered 2 Chords  
#
b
b
#
C
D
C
E
C
F
C
G
C
A
B
B
C
C m Dm Fm  
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
b
b
b
Gm Am B m Ddim A 7 F7 Fm7 Gm7 A add9  
Cm  
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
Cdim  
Caug *3  
Csus4 *3  
Csus2 *3  
C7  
• With Fingered 3, the lowest note fingered is interpreted as  
the base note. Inverted forms are not supported.  
• With Full Range Chord, when the lowest note fingered is a  
certain distance from the neighboring note, the chord is  
interpreted as a fraction chord.  
• Unlike Fingered 1, 2, and 3, Full Range Chord requires  
pressing of at least three keys to form a chord.  
Supported Input Characters  
Cm7 *3  
CM7  
Cm7b5 *3  
C7b5 *3  
C7sus4  
Cadd9  
Cmadd9  
CmM7  
Cdim7 *3  
C69 *3  
C6 *1 *3  
Cm6 *2 *3  
*1 With Fingered 2, interpreted as Am7.  
b
*2 With Fingered 2, interpreted as Am7 5.  
*3 Inverted form not supported in some cases.  
E-155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
E-156  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
Part name  
Assigning a MIDI Channel to Each Part  
The following shows the relationship between MIDI IN and MIDI OUT channels and each part.  
MIDI Channel  
MIDI Channel  
This  
part:  
This  
part:  
Part name  
IN  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
--  
OUT  
01*  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
--  
09  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
IN  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
OUT  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
A01  
A02  
A03  
A04  
A05  
A06  
A07  
A08  
A09  
A10  
A11  
A12  
A13  
A14  
A15  
A16  
Upper1  
Upper2  
Lower  
B01  
B02  
B03  
B04  
B05  
B06  
B07  
B08  
B09  
B10  
B11  
B12  
B13  
B14  
B15  
B16  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 01  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 02  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 03  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 04  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 05  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 06  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 07  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 08  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 09  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 10  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 11  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 12  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 13  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 14  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 15  
SEQUENCER TRACK/MIDI 16  
Harmonize  
System Upper1  
System Upper2  
System Lower  
Metronome  
Percussion  
Drum  
Bass  
Chord1  
Chord2  
Chord3  
Chord4  
Chord5  
* The A01 part MIDI OUT channel depends on the keybaord channel setting. For details, see “KeyboardCh (Keyboard Channel)”  
(page E-128).  
• For details about parts, see “How Parts are Organized” (page E-38).  
E-157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reference  
Parameter List  
Refer to this column in  
the table below:  
To check this setting item:  
Setting items that are always saved when power is turned off  
Setting items stored in registration memory (page E-61)  
1
2
When “on” is selected for the “AutoResume (Auto Resume)” setting (page E-129), setting items  
that are restored to those in effect the last time power was turned off  
3
Items that are stored as “Default (Default Settings)” (page E-129)  
Settings items initialized by the “To initialize all mixer parameters” operation (page E-40)  
4
5
Setting items initialized when “Parameter” (parameter settings only) is selected by “Initialize  
(Initialize)” (page E-129)  
Setting Item  
User Memory Items  
Setting Item  
1
2
3
4
5
1
2
O
O
O*2  
O*2  
3
O
O
O
4
5
O
O
O
Chorus Type  
DSP Type  
Tempo  
User rhythms, user tones, user DSPs,  
user presets  
O
O
Registration, scale memory  
Function Menu Item  
Tuning  
Synchro Standby  
Scale Preset Number  
Scale Root  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Scale Fine Tuning  
O*4  
O*4  
O*2  
Touch Response  
Touch Off Velocity  
Pedal Assign  
O
O
O
Accompaniment Scale  
Accompaniment Part On/Off  
Mode (Rhythm/Card) Selection Status  
Card Song number  
O
O
Bend Range*1  
O
Arpeggiator Hold  
Arpeggiator Speed  
Arpeggiator Part  
O
O
O
O
O
O
Left-hand Part Select  
Right-hand Part Select  
Registration Bank Number  
Rhythm Category Number  
Tone Category Number  
Music Preset Category Number  
Mixer Settings for Part A01 through A04  
Part On/Off*1  
O
O
O
O
O
O
Registration Filter  
(Accompaniment/Scale)  
O
O
O
O
Song Pre-count Sound  
Song Repeat Play  
Auto Accompaniment Volume  
Song Volume  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O*2  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Metronome Volume  
Audio Volume  
O
Part Volume*1  
Part Pan*1  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Keyboard Channel  
Local Control  
Part Coarse Tuning*1  
Part Fine Tuning*1  
Part Bend Range*1  
Part DSP Line On/Off*1  
Part Reverb Send*1  
Part Chorus Send*1  
Part Scale Enable*1  
Accompaniment MIDI Out  
Speaker ON/OFF  
LCD Contrast  
O
O
O
O
Auto Power Off  
O
Auto Recover  
Other Items  
Tone Number*1  
Mixer Settings for Master, DSP and MIC/  
INST, and for Parts A05 through A16, and  
Parts B01 through B16  
O
O*2  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
Rhythm Number  
Music Preset Number  
Transpose  
*1 Configured for each of the following parts: A01 through  
O
O
O
O
O
O*2  
O*2  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
A04 (UPPER 1, UPPER 2, LOWER, Auto Harmonize).  
*2 Not recalled when “on” is selected for “RegFltAcmp” (page  
E-127).  
*3 Configured for each of the following parts: A01 through  
A03 (UPPER 1, UPPER 2, LOWER).  
*4 Not recalled when “on” is selected for “RegFltScal” (page  
E-127).  
Split On/Off  
Split Point  
Layer On/Off  
Octave Shift*3  
Accompaniment On/Off  
Chord Fingering Mode  
Auto Harmonize On/Off/Type  
Metronome Beat  
Chorus/DSP  
DSP Disable  
Reverb (On, Off, Type)  
O
O
E-158  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This recycle mark indicates that the packaging conforms to  
the environmental protection legislation in Germany.  
K
MA1011-B Printed in China  
AT3/AT5-E-1B  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Billy Goat Blower QB1004 User Manual
Blue Rhino Gas Grill HBT822W User Manual
Bradley Smoker Plumbing Product SS 3 AST JUV User Manual
Briggs Stratton Portable Generator 030242 User Manual
Brinkmann Gas Grill Heavy Duty Natural Gas Grill User Manual
Broil King Oven 949 24 User Manual
Cadco Microwave Oven CAPO 203 User Manual
Canon Calculator F 719SG User Manual
Cecilware Oven PO 18 User Manual
CFM Fan AFK 0906 User Manual